blob: 1a27dbf962b67fcdee3b0667483a0fd1e9d90867 [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregore9d62932011-07-15 16:25:15 +000041 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
42 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000043 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(),
44 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
45 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
46 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
47 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000048 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
49 if (E.isInvalid())
50 return ExprError();
51 return move(E);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000052}
53
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000054static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
55 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000056 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +000057 bool CStyle,
58 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000059
60static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
61 QualType &ToType,
62 bool InOverloadResolution,
63 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
64 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000065static OverloadingResult
66IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
67 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
68 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
69 bool AllowExplicit);
70
71
72static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
73CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
74 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
75 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
76
77static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
78CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
79 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
80 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
81
82static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
83CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
84 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
85 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
86
87
88
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000089/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
90/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000091ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000092GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
93 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
94 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
95 ICC_Identity,
96 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
97 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
98 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000099 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
101 ICC_Promotion,
102 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000103 ICC_Promotion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
105 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000106 ICC_Conversion,
107 ICC_Conversion,
108 ICC_Conversion,
109 ICC_Conversion,
110 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000111 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000113 ICC_Conversion,
114 ICC_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000115 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000116 ICC_Conversion
117 };
118 return Category[(int)Kind];
119}
120
121/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
122/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
123ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
124 static const ImplicitConversionRank
125 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
126 ICR_Exact_Match,
127 ICR_Exact_Match,
128 ICR_Exact_Match,
129 ICR_Exact_Match,
130 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000131 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000132 ICR_Promotion,
133 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000134 ICR_Promotion,
135 ICR_Conversion,
136 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
139 ICR_Conversion,
140 ICR_Conversion,
141 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000142 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000143 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000144 ICR_Conversion,
145 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000146 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
147 ICR_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000148 ICR_Conversion,
149 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 };
151 return Rank[(int)Kind];
152}
153
154/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
155/// implicit conversion.
156const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000157 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000158 "No conversion",
159 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
160 "Array-to-pointer",
161 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000162 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000163 "Qualification",
164 "Integral promotion",
165 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000166 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000167 "Integral conversion",
168 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000169 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000170 "Floating-integral conversion",
171 "Pointer conversion",
172 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000173 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000174 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000175 "Derived-to-base conversion",
176 "Vector conversion",
177 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000178 "Complex-real conversion",
179 "Block Pointer conversion",
180 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000181 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000182 };
183 return Name[Kind];
184}
185
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000186/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
187/// sequence to the identity conversion.
188void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
189 First = ICK_Identity;
190 Second = ICK_Identity;
191 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000192 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000193 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000194 ReferenceBinding = false;
195 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000196 IsLvalueReference = true;
197 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
198 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000199 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000200 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000201 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000202}
203
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000204/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
205/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
206/// implicit conversions.
207ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
208 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
209 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
210 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
211 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
212 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
213 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
214 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
215 return Rank;
216}
217
218/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
219/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000220/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000222bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000223 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
224 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
225 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
226 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000227 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000228 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
229 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
230 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000231 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000232 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
233 return true;
234
235 return false;
236}
237
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000238/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
239/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
240/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
241/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000242bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000243StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000244isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000245 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000246 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000247
248 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
249 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
250 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
251 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
252 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
253
Douglas Gregor5d3d3fa2011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000254 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000255 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000256 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
257
258 return false;
259}
260
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000261/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
262/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
263static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
264 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
265 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
266 case CK_NoOp:
267 case CK_IntegralCast:
268 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
269 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
270 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
271 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
272 case CK_FloatingCast:
273 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
274 continue;
275
276 default:
277 return Converted;
278 }
279 }
280
281 return Converted;
282}
283
284/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
285/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
286///
287/// \param Ctx The AST context.
288/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
289/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
290/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
291NarrowingKind
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000292StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
293 const Expr *Converted,
294 APValue &ConstantValue) const {
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000295 assert(Ctx.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
296
297 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
298 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
299 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
300 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
301 switch (Second) {
302 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
303 //
304 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
305 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
306 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
307 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
308 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
309 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
310 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
311 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
312 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
313 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
314 if (Initializer &&
315 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
316 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
317 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
318 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
319 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
320 // And back.
321 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
322 bool ignored;
323 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
324 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
325 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
326 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
327 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
328 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
329 }
330 } else {
331 // Variables are always narrowings.
332 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
333 }
334 }
335 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
336
337 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
338 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
339 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
340 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
341 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
342 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
343 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
344 // FromType is larger than ToType.
345 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
346 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
347 // Constant!
348 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
349 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
350 // Convert the source value into the target type.
351 bool ignored;
352 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
353 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
354 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
355 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
356 // values that can be represented.
357 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow)
358 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
359 } else {
360 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
361 }
362 }
363 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
364
365 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
366 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
367 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
368 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
369 // value when converted back to the original type.
370 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
371 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
372 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
373 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
374 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
375 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
376 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
377 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
378 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
379 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
380 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
381 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
382 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
383
384 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
385 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned)) {
386 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
387 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
388 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
389 if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
390 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
391
392 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
393 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
394 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
395 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
396 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
397 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
398 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
399 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
400 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
401 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
402 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
403 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
404 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
405 } else {
406 // Variables are always narrowings.
407 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
408 }
409 }
410 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
411 }
412
413 default:
414 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
415 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
416 }
417}
418
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000419/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
420/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
421void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000422 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000423 bool PrintedSomething = false;
424 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000425 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000426 PrintedSomething = true;
427 }
428
429 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
430 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000431 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000432 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000433 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000434
435 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000436 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000437 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000438 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000439 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000440 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000441 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000442 PrintedSomething = true;
443 }
444
445 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
446 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000447 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000448 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000449 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000450 PrintedSomething = true;
451 }
452
453 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000454 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455 }
456}
457
458/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
459/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
460void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000461 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000462 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
463 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000464 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000465 }
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000466 if (ConversionFunction)
467 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
468 else
469 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000470 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000471 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000472 After.DebugPrint();
473 }
474}
475
476/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
477/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
478void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000479 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000480 switch (ConversionKind) {
481 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000482 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000483 Standard.DebugPrint();
484 break;
485 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000486 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000487 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
488 break;
489 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000490 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000491 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000492 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000493 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000494 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000495 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000496 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000497 break;
498 }
499
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000500 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000501}
502
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000503void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
504 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
505}
506
507void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
508 conversions().~ConversionSet();
509}
510
511void
512AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
513 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
514 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
515 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
516}
517
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000518namespace {
519 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
520 // template parameter and template argument information.
521 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
522 TemplateParameter Param;
523 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
524 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
525 };
526}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000527
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000528/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
529/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
530OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000531static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
532 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000533 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000534 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
535 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
536 Result.Data = 0;
537 switch (TDK) {
538 case Sema::TDK_Success:
539 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000540 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
541 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000542 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000543
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000544 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000545 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000546 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
547 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000548
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000549 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000550 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000551 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
552 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000553 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
554 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
555 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
556 Result.Data = Saved;
557 break;
558 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000559
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000560 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000561 Result.Data = Info.take();
562 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000563
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000564 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000565 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000566 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000567 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000568
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000569 return Result;
570}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000571
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000572void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
573 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
574 case Sema::TDK_Success:
575 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
576 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000577 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
578 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000579 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000580 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000581
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000582 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000583 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000584 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000585 Data = 0;
586 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000587
588 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
589 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
590 Data = 0;
591 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000592
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000593 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000594 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000595 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
596 break;
597 }
598}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000599
600TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000601OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
602 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
603 case Sema::TDK_Success:
604 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000605 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
606 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000607 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000608 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000609
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000610 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000611 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000612 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000613
614 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000615 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000616 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000617
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000618 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000619 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000620 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
621 break;
622 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000623
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000624 return TemplateParameter();
625}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000626
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000627TemplateArgumentList *
628OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
629 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
630 case Sema::TDK_Success:
631 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
632 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
633 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
634 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
635 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
636 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000637 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000638 return 0;
639
640 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
641 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000642
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000643 // Unhandled
644 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
645 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
646 break;
647 }
648
649 return 0;
650}
651
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000652const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
653 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
654 case Sema::TDK_Success:
655 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
656 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000657 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
658 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000659 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000660 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000661 return 0;
662
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000663 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000664 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000665 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000666
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000667 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000668 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000669 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
670 break;
671 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000672
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000674}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000675
676const TemplateArgument *
677OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
678 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
679 case Sema::TDK_Success:
680 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
681 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000682 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
683 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000684 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000685 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000686 return 0;
687
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000688 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000689 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000690 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
691
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000692 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000693 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000694 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
695 break;
696 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000697
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000698 return 0;
699}
700
701void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Benjamin Kramer02b08432012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000702 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i)
703 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
704 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Benjamin Kramer0b9c5092012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000705 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000706 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000707 Functions.clear();
708}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000709
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000710namespace {
711 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
712 struct Entry {
713 Expr **Addr;
714 Expr *Saved;
715 };
716 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
717
718 public:
719 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
720 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
721 Entry entry = { &E, E };
722 Entries.push_back(entry);
723 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
724 }
725
726 void restore() {
727 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
728 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
729 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
730 }
731 };
732}
733
734/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
735/// preprocessing on the given expression.
736///
737/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
738/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
739///
740/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
741static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
742 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000743 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
744 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
745 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
746 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
747
748 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
749 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
750 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
751 unbridgedCasts) {
752 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
753 return false;
754 }
755
756 // Go ahead and check everything else.
757 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
758 if (result.isInvalid())
759 return true;
760
761 E = result.take();
762 return false;
763 }
764
765 // Nothing to do.
766 return false;
767}
768
769/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
770/// placeholders.
771static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
772 unsigned numArgs,
773 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
774 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
775 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
776 return true;
777
778 return false;
779}
780
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000781// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000782// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
783// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
784// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
785// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000786// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
787// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
788// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000789//
790// Example: Given the following input:
791//
792// void f(int, float); // #1
793// void f(int, int); // #2
794// int f(int, int); // #3
795//
796// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000797// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000798//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000799// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
800// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
801// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
802// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000803//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000804// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
805// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
806// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
807// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000808// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
809// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000810//
811// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
812// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
813// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
814// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000815Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000816Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
817 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000818 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000819 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000820 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
821
822 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
823 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
824 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
825
826 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
827 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
828 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
829
830 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
831 }
832
833 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
834 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
835 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
836 // function templates hide function templates with different
837 // return types or template parameter lists.
838 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
839 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
840
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000841 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000842 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
843 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
844 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
845 continue;
846 }
847
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000848 Match = *I;
849 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000850 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000851 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000852 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
853 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
854 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
855 continue;
856 }
857
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000858 Match = *I;
859 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000860 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000861 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000862 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
863 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
864 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000865 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
866 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000867 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
868 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
869 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
870 // template instantiation.
871 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000872 // (C++ 13p1):
873 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
874 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000875 Match = *I;
876 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000877 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000878 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000879
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000880 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000881}
882
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000883bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
884 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000885 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
886 // overloads.
887 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
888 return false;
889
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000890 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
891 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
892
893 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
894 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
895 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
896 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
897 return true;
898
899 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
900 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
901 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
902
903 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
904 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
905 // in the signature, they are overloads.
906
907 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
908 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
909 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
910 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
911 return false;
912
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000913 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
914 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000915
916 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
917 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
918 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
919 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
920 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
921 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000922 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000923 return true;
924
925 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
926 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
927 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
928 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
929 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
930 // signature.
931 //
932 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
933 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000934 //
935 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
936 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
937 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000938 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
939 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
940 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
941 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
942 return true;
943
944 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000945 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000946 //
947 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
948 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
949 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
950 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
951 // can be overloaded.
952 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
953 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
954 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
955 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000956 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000957 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
958 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
959 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
960 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
961 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
962 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000963 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
964 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
965 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
966 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000967 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
968 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
969 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
970 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
971 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000972
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000973 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000974 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000975
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000976 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
977 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000978}
979
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +0000980/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
981/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
982///
983/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
984/// an available function, false otherwise.
985bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
986 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
987}
988
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +0000989/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
990///
991/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
992/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
993static ImplicitConversionSequence
994TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
995 bool SuppressUserConversions,
996 bool AllowExplicit,
997 bool InOverloadResolution,
998 bool CStyle,
999 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1000 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1001
1002 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1003 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1004 // we can perform.
1005 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1006 return ICS;
1007 }
1008
1009 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1010 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1011 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1012 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1013 AllowExplicit);
1014
1015 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1016 ICS.setUserDefined();
1017 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1018 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1019 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1020 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1021 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1022 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1023 // called for those cases.
1024 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1025 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1026 QualType FromCanon
1027 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1028 QualType ToCanon
1029 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1030 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1031 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1032 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1033 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1034 ICS.setStandard();
1035 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1036 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1037 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1038 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1039 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1040 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1041 }
1042 }
1043
1044 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1045 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1046 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1047 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1048 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1049 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1050 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1051 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1052 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1053 }
1054 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1055 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1056 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1057 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1058 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1059 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1060 if (Cand->Viable)
1061 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1062 } else {
1063 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1064 }
1065
1066 return ICS;
1067}
1068
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001069/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1070/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1071/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1072/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001073///
1074/// void f(float f);
1075/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1076///
1077/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1078/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1079/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1080/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1081//
1082/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1083/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1084/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1085/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1086/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001087///
1088/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1089/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001090/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1091/// permitted.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001092///
1093/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1094/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1095/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001096static ImplicitConversionSequence
1097TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1098 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001099 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001100 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001101 bool CStyle,
1102 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001103 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001104 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001105 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001106 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001107 return ICS;
1108 }
1109
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001110 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001111 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001112 return ICS;
1113 }
1114
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001115 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1116 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1117 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1118 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1119 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1120 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1121 // called for those cases.
1122 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1123 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001124 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1125 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001126 ICS.setStandard();
1127 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1128 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1129 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001130
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001131 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1132 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1133 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1134 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1135 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001136
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001137 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001138 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001139 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001140
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001141 return ICS;
1142 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001143
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001144 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1145 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1146 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001147}
1148
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001149ImplicitConversionSequence
1150Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1151 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1152 bool AllowExplicit,
1153 bool InOverloadResolution,
1154 bool CStyle,
1155 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1156 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1157 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1158 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1159 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001160}
1161
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001162/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001163/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001164/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1165/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1166/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001167ExprResult
1168Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001169 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001170 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001171 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001172}
1173
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001174ExprResult
1175Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001176 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001177 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001178 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1179 return ExprError();
1180
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001181 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1182 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1183 = getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1184 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001185
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001186 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1187 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1188 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001189 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001190 /*CStyle=*/false,
1191 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001192 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1193}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001194
1195/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001196/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001197bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1198 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001199 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1200 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001201
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001202 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1203 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1204 // - a pointer
1205 // - a member pointer
1206 // - a block pointer
1207 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1208 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1209 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1210 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1211 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1212 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1213 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1214 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1215 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1216 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1217 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1218 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1219 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1220 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1221 } else {
1222 return false;
1223 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001224
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001225 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1226 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1227 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1228 return false;
1229 }
1230
1231 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1232 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1233 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1234
1235 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1236 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1237 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1238
1239 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001240 return true;
1241}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001242
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001243/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1244/// vector conversion.
1245///
1246/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1247/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001248static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1249 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001250 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1251 // conversion.
1252 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1253 return false;
1254
1255 // Identical types require no conversions.
1256 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1257 return false;
1258
1259 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1260 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1261 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1262 // identity conversion.
1263 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1264 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001265
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001266 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001267 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001268 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1269 return true;
1270 }
1271 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001272
1273 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1274 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1275 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1276 // same size
1277 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1278 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001279 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
1280 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001281 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1282 return true;
1283 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001284 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001285
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001286 return false;
1287}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001288
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001289/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1290/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1291/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1292/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1293/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1294/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1295/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1296/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001297static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1298 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001299 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001300 bool CStyle,
1301 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001302 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001303
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001304 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001305 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001306 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001307 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001308 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001309 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001310
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001311 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001312 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001313 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001314 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001315 return false;
1316
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001317 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001318 }
1319
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001320 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1321 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1322 // (C++ 4p1).
1323
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001324 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001325 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1326 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001327 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001328 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001329 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1330 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1331 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001332
1333 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1334 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1335 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1336 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1337 QualType resultTy;
1338 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001339 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001340 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1341 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1342 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1343 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001344 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001345
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001346 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1347 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1348 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1349 // expression.
1350 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1351 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1352 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1353 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1354 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1355 == UO_AddrOf &&
1356 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1357 const Type *ClassType
1358 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1359 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001360 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1361 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1362 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001363 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1364 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1365 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001366
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001367 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001368 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1369 FromType,
1370 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001371 } else {
1372 return false;
1373 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001374 }
John McCall154a2fd2011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001375 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1376 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1377 // be converted to a prvalue.
1378 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001379 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001380 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001381 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001382 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001383
1384 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1385 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001386 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1387 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001388 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001389 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1390 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001391 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001392
1393 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1394 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1395 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001396 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001397
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001398 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001399 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001400 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001401
1402 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1403 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1404 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1405 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001406 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1407 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001408 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001409 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001410 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001411 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001412 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001413 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001414 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001415
1416 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1417 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1418 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001419 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001420 } else {
1421 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001422 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001423 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001424 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001425
1426 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1427 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1428 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1429 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001430 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1431 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001432 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001433 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001434 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001435 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1436 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001437 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001438 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001439 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001440 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001441 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001442 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001443 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001444 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001445 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001446 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001447 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001448 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1449 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001450 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1451 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1452 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1453 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1454 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1455 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1456 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1457 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1458 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001459 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001460 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001461 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001462 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001463 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001464 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001465 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001466 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1467 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001468 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1469 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001470 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1471 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1472 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001473 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001474 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1475 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1476 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001477 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001478 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001479 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001480 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001481 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001482 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001483 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001484 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001485 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1486 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1487 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1488 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001489 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1490 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001491 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001492 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001493 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001494 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001495 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001496 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001497 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001498 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001499 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001500 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1501 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001502 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1503 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001504 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001505 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001506 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001507 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001508 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1509 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001510 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1511 InOverloadResolution,
1512 SCS, CStyle)) {
1513 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1514 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001515 } else {
1516 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001517 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001518 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001519 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001520
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001521 QualType CanonFrom;
1522 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001523 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001524 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1525 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1526 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001527 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001528 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001529 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001530 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1531 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001532 } else {
1533 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001534 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1535
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001536 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001537 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1538 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1539 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001540 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1541 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001542 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001543 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001544 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001545 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
1546 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001547 FromType = ToType;
1548 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1549 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001550 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001551 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001552
1553 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1554 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001555 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001556 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001557
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001558 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001559}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001560
1561static bool
1562IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1563 QualType &ToType,
1564 bool InOverloadResolution,
1565 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1566 bool CStyle) {
1567
1568 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1569 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1570 return false;
1571 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1572 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1573 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1574 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1575 itend = UD->field_end();
1576 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001577 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1578 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001579 ToType = it->getType();
1580 return true;
1581 }
1582 }
1583 return false;
1584}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001585
1586/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1587/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1588/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1589/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001590bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001591 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001592 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001593 if (!To) {
1594 return false;
1595 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001596
1597 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1598 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1599 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1600 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1601 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001602 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1603 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001604 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1605 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1606 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1607 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001608 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001609 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001610 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001611 }
1612
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001613 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1614 }
1615
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001616 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1617 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1618 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1619 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1620 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1621 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001622 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001623 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001624 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001625 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1626 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001627 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001628 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1629 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1630 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1631 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1632 return false;
1633
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001634 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001635 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001636 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001637 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1638 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001639 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001640
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001641 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001642 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1643 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1644 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001645 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001646 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001647 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001648 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001649 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001650 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001651 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001652 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1653 // unsigned.
David Majnemerfa01a582011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001654 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001655 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001656
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001657 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1658 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001659 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1660 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001661 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1662 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001663 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001664 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001665 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1666 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001667 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001668 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1669 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1670 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1671 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001672 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001673 }
1674 }
1675 }
1676
1677 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1678 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1679 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1680 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1681 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1682 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1683 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001684 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1685 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001686 using llvm::APSInt;
1687 if (From)
1688 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001689 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001690 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001691 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1692 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1693 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001694
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001695 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1696 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1697 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1698 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1699 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001700
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001701 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1702 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1703 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1704 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1705 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001706
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001707 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001708 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001709 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001710
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001711 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1712 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001713 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001714 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001715 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001716
1717 return false;
1718}
1719
1720/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1721/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1722/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001723bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001724 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1725 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001726 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1727 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001728 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1729 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1730 return true;
1731
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001732 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1733 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1734 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1735 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1736 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1737 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1738 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1739 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001740
1741 // Half can be promoted to float.
1742 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
1743 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1744 return true;
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001745 }
1746
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001747 return false;
1748}
1749
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001750/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1751///
1752/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1753/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001754/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001755bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001756 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001757 if (!FromComplex)
1758 return false;
1759
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001760 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001761 if (!ToComplex)
1762 return false;
1763
1764 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001765 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1766 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1767 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001768}
1769
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001770/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1771/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1772/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1773/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1774/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001775///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001776static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001777BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001778 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001779 ASTContext &Context,
1780 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001781 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1782 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1783 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001785 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1786 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001787 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001788
1789 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001790 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001791 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001792 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001793
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001794 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1795 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1796
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001797 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001798 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001799 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001800 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001801 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001802
1803 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1804 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001805 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1806 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001807 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1808 }
1809
1810 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001811 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1812 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001813
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001814 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1815 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1816 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001817}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001818
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001819static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001820 bool InOverloadResolution,
1821 ASTContext &Context) {
1822 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1823 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1824 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001825 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001826 return !InOverloadResolution;
1827
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001828 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1829 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1830 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001831}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001832
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001833/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1834/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1835/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1836/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1837/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1838/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001839///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001840/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1841/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1842/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1843/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1844/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1845/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001846/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1847/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1848/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001849bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001850 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001851 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001852 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001853 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001854 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1855 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001856 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001857
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001858 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1859 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001860 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001861 ConvertedType = ToType;
1862 return true;
1863 }
1864
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001865 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1866 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001867 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001868 ConvertedType = ToType;
1869 return true;
1870 }
1871 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1872 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001873 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001874 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001875 ConvertedType = ToType;
1876 return true;
1877 }
1878
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001879 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1880 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001881 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001882 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001883 ConvertedType = ToType;
1884 return true;
1885 }
1886
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001887 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001888 if (!ToTypePtr)
1889 return false;
1890
1891 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001892 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001893 ConvertedType = ToType;
1894 return true;
1895 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001896
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001897 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001898 // , including objective-c pointers.
1899 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001900 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
1901 !getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001902 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1903 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1904 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001905 ToType, Context);
1906 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001907 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001908 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001909 if (!FromTypePtr)
1910 return false;
1911
1912 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001913
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001914 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001915 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1916 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1917 return false;
1918
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001919 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1920 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1921 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001922 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1923 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001924 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001925 ToPointeeType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001926 ToType, Context,
1927 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001928 return true;
1929 }
1930
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001931 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +00001932 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001933 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
1934 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1935 ToPointeeType,
1936 ToType, Context);
1937 return true;
1938 }
1939
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001940 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1941 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001942 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001943 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001944 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001945 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001946 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001947 return true;
1948 }
1949
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001950 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001951 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001952 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1953 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1954 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1955 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1956 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1957 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1958 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1959 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1960 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001961 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1962 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001963 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1964 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001965 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001966 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001967 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001968 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001969 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001970 ToType, Context);
1971 return true;
1972 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001973
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00001974 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1975 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1976 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1977 ToPointeeType,
1978 ToType, Context);
1979 return true;
1980 }
1981
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001982 return false;
1983}
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001984
1985/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
1986static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
1987 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
1988
1989 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
1990 if (TQs == Qs)
1991 return T;
1992
1993 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
1994 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
1995
1996 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
1997}
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001998
1999/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2000/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2001/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002002bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002003 QualType& ConvertedType,
2004 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2005 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
2006 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002007
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002008 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2009 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2010
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002011 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002012 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2013 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002014 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002015 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002016
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002017 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002018 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2019 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2020 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2021 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2022 return false;
2023
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002024 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002025 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002026 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002027 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002028 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002029 return true;
2030 }
2031 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002032 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002033 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002034 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002035 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002036 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002037 return true;
2038 }
2039 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2040 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2041 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002042 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2043 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2044 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2045 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2046 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2047 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002048 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002049 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2050 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002051 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002052 return true;
2053 }
2054
2055 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2056 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2057 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2058 // complain about it.
2059 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002060 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002061 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2062 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002063 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002064 return true;
2065 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002067 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002068 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002069 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002070 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002071 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002072 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002073 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002074 // to a block pointer type.
2075 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002076 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002077 return true;
2078 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002079 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002080 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002081 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002082 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002083 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002084 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002085 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002086 return true;
2087 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002088 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002089 return false;
2090
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002091 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002092 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002093 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002094 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2095 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002096 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2097 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002098 return false;
2099
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002100 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2101 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2102 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2103 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2104 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2105 // We always complain about this conversion.
2106 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002107 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002108 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002109 return true;
2110 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002111 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2112 // as in I* to id.
2113 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2114 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2115 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2116 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002117
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002118 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002119 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002120 return true;
2121 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002122
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002123 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002124 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2125 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2126 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002127 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002128 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002129 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002130 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002131 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2132 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2133 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2134 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2135 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2136 return false;
2137
2138 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2139 // function types are obviously different.
2140 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2141 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2142 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2143 return false;
2144
2145 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2146 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2147 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2148 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2149 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2150 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2151 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2152 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2153 HasObjCConversion = true;
2154 } else {
2155 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2156 return false;
2157 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002159 // Check argument types.
2160 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2161 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2162 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2163 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2164 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2165 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2166 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2167 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2168 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2169 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2170 HasObjCConversion = true;
2171 } else {
2172 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2173 return false;
2174 }
2175 }
2176
2177 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2178 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2179 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002180 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002181 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2182 return true;
2183 }
2184 }
2185
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002186 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002187}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002188
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002189/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2190/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2191///
2192/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2193///
2194/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2195///
2196/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2197/// this conversion.
2198bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2199 QualType &ConvertedType) {
2200 if (!getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2201 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2202 return false;
2203
2204 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2205 QualType ToPointee;
2206 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2207 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2208 else
2209 return false;
2210
2211 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2212 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2213 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002214 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002215 return false;
2216
2217 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2218 QualType FromPointee;
2219 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2220 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2221 else
2222 return false;
2223
2224 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2225 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2226 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2227 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2228 return false;
2229
2230 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2231 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2232 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2233 return false;
2234
2235 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2236 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2237 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2238 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2239
2240 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2241 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2242 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2243 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2244 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2245 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2246 IncompatibleObjC))
2247 return false;
2248
2249 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2250 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2251 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2252 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2253 return true;
2254}
2255
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002256bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2257 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2258 QualType ToPointeeType;
2259 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2260 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2261 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2262 else
2263 return false;
2264
2265 QualType FromPointeeType;
2266 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2267 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2268 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2269 else
2270 return false;
2271 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2272 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2273 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2274
2275 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2276 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2277 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2278 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2279
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002280 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2281 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002282
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002283 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002284 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002285
2286 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2287 // function types are obviously different.
2288 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2289 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2290 return false;
2291
2292 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2293 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2294 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2295 return false;
2296
2297 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian12834e12011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002298 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2299 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002300 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2301 } else {
2302 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2303 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
2304 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2305 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2306 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2307
2308 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2309 // OK exact match.
2310 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2311 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2312 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2313 return false;
2314 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2315 }
2316 else
2317 return false;
2318 }
2319
2320 // Check argument types.
2321 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2322 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2323 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2324 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2325 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2326 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2327 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2328 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2329 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2330 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2331 return false;
2332 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2333 } else
2334 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2335 return false;
2336 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002337 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2338 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2339 ToFunctionType))
2340 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian600ba202011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002341
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002342 ConvertedType = ToType;
2343 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002344}
2345
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002346enum {
2347 ft_default,
2348 ft_different_class,
2349 ft_parameter_arity,
2350 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2351 ft_return_type,
2352 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2353};
2354
2355/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2356/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2357/// parameter types, and different return types.
2358void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2359 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002360 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2361 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2362 PDiag << ft_default;
2363 return;
2364 }
2365
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002366 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2367 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2368 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2369 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2370 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2371 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2372 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2373 return;
2374 }
2375 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2376 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002377 }
2378
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002379 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2380 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2381 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2382 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2383
2384 // Remove references.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002385 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2386 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2387
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002388 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2389 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2390 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2391 PDiag << ft_default;
2392 return;
2393 }
2394
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002395 // No extra info for same types.
2396 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2397 PDiag << ft_default;
2398 return;
2399 }
2400
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002401 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2402 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2403
2404 // Both types need to be function types.
2405 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2406 PDiag << ft_default;
2407 return;
2408 }
2409
2410 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2411 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2412 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2413 return;
2414 }
2415
2416 // Handle different parameter types.
2417 unsigned ArgPos;
2418 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2419 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2420 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2421 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2422 return;
2423 }
2424
2425 // Handle different return type.
2426 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2427 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2428 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2429 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2430 return;
2431 }
2432
2433 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2434 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2435 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2436 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2437 return;
2438 }
2439
2440 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2441 PDiag << ft_default;
2442}
2443
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002444/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregor2039ca02011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002445/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002446/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2447/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002448/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the the parameter index
2449/// of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002450bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002451 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2452 unsigned *ArgPos) {
2453 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1) {
2454 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2455 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2456 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2457 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
2458 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2459 return false;
2460 }
2461 }
2462 return true;
2463 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002464
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002465 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2466 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2467 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2468 QualType ToType = (*O);
2469 QualType FromType = (*N);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002470 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) {
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002471 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2472 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002473 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2474 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2475 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2476 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002477 continue;
2478 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002479 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2480 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002481 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002482 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2039ca02011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002483 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2484 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(),
2485 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType()))
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002486 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002487 }
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002488 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002489 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002490 }
2491 }
2492 return true;
2493}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002494
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002495/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2496/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002497/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002498/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2499/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2500/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002501bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002502 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002503 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002504 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002505 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002506 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002507
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002508 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2509
Chandler Carruthffab8732011-04-09 07:32:05 +00002510 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2511 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
2512 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
2513 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
Chandler Carruth66a7b042011-04-09 07:48:17 +00002514 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2515 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00002516
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002517 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2518 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002519 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2520 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002521
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002522 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2523 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002524 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2525 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002526 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2527 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002528 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002529 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002530 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002531
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002532 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002533 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002534 }
2535 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002536 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2537 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2538 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2539 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002540 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2541 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2542 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002543 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002544 return false;
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002545 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2546 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2547 } else {
2548 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002549 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002550 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2551 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2552 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002553 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002554
2555 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2556 // reasons.
2557 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2558 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2559
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002560 return false;
2561}
2562
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002563/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2564/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2565/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2566/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2567/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2568bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002569 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002570 bool InOverloadResolution,
2571 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002572 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002573 if (!ToTypePtr)
2574 return false;
2575
2576 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002577 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2578 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2579 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002580 ConvertedType = ToType;
2581 return true;
2582 }
2583
2584 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002585 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002586 if (!FromTypePtr)
2587 return false;
2588
2589 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2590 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2591 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2592 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002593
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002594 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2595 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2596 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002597 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2598 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2599 return true;
2600 }
2601
2602 return false;
2603}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002604
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002605/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2606/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002607/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002608/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2609/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2610/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002611bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002612 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002613 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002614 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002615 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002616 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002617 if (!FromPtrType) {
2618 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002619 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002620 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002621 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002622 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002623 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002624 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002625
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002626 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002627 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2628 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002629
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002630 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2631 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002632
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002633 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2634 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2635 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002636
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002637 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002638 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002639 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2640 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2641 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2642 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002643
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002644 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2645 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002646 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2647 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2648 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2649 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002650 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002651
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002652 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002653 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2654 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2655 << From->getSourceRange();
2656 return true;
2657 }
2658
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002659 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002660 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2661 Paths.front(),
2662 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002663
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002664 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002665 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002666 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002667 return false;
2668}
2669
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002670/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2671/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2672/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002673///
2674/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2675/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2676/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002677bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002678Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002679 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002680 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2681 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002682 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2683
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002684 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2685 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002686 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002687 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002688
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002689 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2690 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2691 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2692 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002693 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002694 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002695 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2696 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2697 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002698 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002699 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2700 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002701 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002702
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002703 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2704 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2705
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002706 // Objective-C ARC:
2707 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2708 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2709 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2710 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2711 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2712 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2713 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2714 } else {
2715 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2716 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2717 return false;
2718 }
2719 }
2720
Douglas Gregorf30053d2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002721 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2722 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2723 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2724 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2725 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2726 }
2727
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002728 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2729 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002730 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002731 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002732
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002733 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2734 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002735 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002736 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002737 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002738
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002739 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2740 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002741 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002742 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002743 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002744
2745 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2746 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2747 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2748 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2749 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002750 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002751}
2752
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002753static OverloadingResult
2754IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2755 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2756 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2757 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2758 bool AllowExplicit) {
2759 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
2760 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2761 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2762 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2763 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2764
2765 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2766 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2767 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2768 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2769 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2770 Constructor
2771 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2772 else
2773 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2774
2775 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2776 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2777 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2778 if (Usable) {
2779 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2780 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2781 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
2782 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2783 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true);
2784 else
2785 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2786 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2787 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true);
2788 }
2789 }
2790
2791 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2792
2793 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2794 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2795 case OR_Success: {
2796 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2797 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
2798 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2799
2800 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2801 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2802 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2803 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2804 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2805 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2806 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2807 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2808 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2809 return OR_Success;
2810 }
2811
2812 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2813 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2814 case OR_Deleted:
2815 return OR_Deleted;
2816 case OR_Ambiguous:
2817 return OR_Ambiguous;
2818 }
2819
2820 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
2821}
2822
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002823/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2824/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2825/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2826/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2827/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2828/// false and User is unspecified.
2829///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002830/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2831/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2832/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002833static OverloadingResult
2834IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002835 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2836 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002837 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002838 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2839 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2840
2841 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2842 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002843 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002844 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2845 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2846 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2847 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2848 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2849 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2850 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2851 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002852 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002853 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002854 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002855 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2856
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7a6f2a32011-04-22 17:45:37 +00002857 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag());
2858 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2859 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2860 // to try to recover.
2861 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002862 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2863 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2864 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002865
2866 Expr **Args = &From;
2867 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
2868 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002869 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Sebastian Redl82ace982012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002870 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work.
2871 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
2872 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
2873 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
2874 return Result;
2875 // Never mind.
2876 CandidateSet.clear();
2877
2878 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
2879 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002880 Args = InitList->getInits();
2881 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
2882 ListInitializing = true;
2883 }
2884
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002885 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002886 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002887 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002888 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2889 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2890
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002891 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2892 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2893 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002894 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002895 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002896 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002897 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2898 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002899 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002900
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002901 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
2902 if (ListInitializing)
2903 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2904 else
2905 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
2906 if (Usable) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002907 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002908 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2909 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002910 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002911 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002912 !ConstructorsOnly &&
2913 !ListInitializing);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002914 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002915 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2916 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002917 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002918 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002919 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002920 !ConstructorsOnly && !ListInitializing);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002921 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002922 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002923 }
2924 }
2925
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002926 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002927 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002928 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2929 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002930 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002931 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002932 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002933 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002934 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2935 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002936 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002937 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002938 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002939 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002940 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2941 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002942 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2943 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2944 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2945
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002946 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2947 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002948 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2949 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002950 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002951 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002952
2953 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2954 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002955 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2956 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2957 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002958 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002959 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2960 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002961 }
2962 }
2963 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002964 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002965
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00002966 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2967
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002968 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002969 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002970 case OR_Success:
2971 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2972 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2973 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00002974 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002975
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002976 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2977 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2978 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2979 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2980 // the argument of the constructor.
2981 //
2982 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002983 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
2984 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2985 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2986 } else {
2987 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2988 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2989 else {
2990 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2991 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
2992 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002993 }
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00002994 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002995 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00002996 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002997 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2998 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2999 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3000 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003001 }
3002 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003003 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00003004 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003005
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003006 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3007 //
3008 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3009 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3010 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3011 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3012 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003013 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003014 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003015 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003016 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003017
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003018 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3019 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3020 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3021 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3022 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3023 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3024 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3025 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3026 // 13.3.3.1).
3027 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3028 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003029 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003030 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003031
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003032 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3033 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3034 case OR_Deleted:
3035 // No conversion here! We're done.
3036 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003037
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003038 case OR_Ambiguous:
3039 return OR_Ambiguous;
3040 }
3041
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003042 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003043}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003044
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003045bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003046Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003047 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003048 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003049 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003050 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003051 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003052 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3053 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3054 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3055 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3056 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
3057 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3058 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3059 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3060 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003061 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003062 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003063 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003064}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003065
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003066/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3067/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3068/// is possible.
3069static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3070compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3071 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3072 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3073 if (!S.getLangOptions().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x)
3074 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3075
3076 // Objective-C++:
3077 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3078 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3079 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3080 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3081 // to keep code working.
3082 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3083 if (!Conv1)
3084 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3085
3086 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3087 if (!Conv2)
3088 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3089
3090 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3091 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3092 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3093 if (Block1 != Block2)
3094 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3095 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3096 }
3097
3098 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3099}
3100
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003101/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3102/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3103/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003104static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3105CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3106 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3107 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003108{
3109 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3110 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3111 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3112 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3113 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3114 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3115 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3116 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003117 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003118 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3119 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3120 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3121 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3122 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003123 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3124 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003125 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003126 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003127
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003128 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3129 // the same kind.
3130 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3131 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3132
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003133 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3134 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3135
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003136 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3137 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3138 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003139 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003140 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3141 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003142 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003143 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3144 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3145 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3146 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3147 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3148 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003149 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003150 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003151 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3152 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3153 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003154 else
3155 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3156 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3157 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003158 }
3159
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003160 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3161 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3162 // for some X and L2 does not.
3163 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
3164 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3165 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
3166 // FIXME: Find out if ICS1 converts to initializer_list and ICS2 doesn't.
3167 }
3168
3169 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003170}
3171
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003172static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3173 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3174 Qualifiers Quals;
3175 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003176 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003177 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003178
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003179 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3180}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003181
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003182// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3183// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3184static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3185compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3186 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3187 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3188 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3189 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3190
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003191 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003192 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor377c1092011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003193 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3194 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3195 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3196 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003197
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003198 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3199 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3200 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3201 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3202 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3203 else
3204 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003205 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003206 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3207
3208 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3209 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3210 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3211 }
3212
3213 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3214 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3215 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3216 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3217
3218 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3219 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3220 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3221 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003222
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003223 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3224}
3225
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003226/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3227/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3228static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3229 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3230 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3231 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3232 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003233 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003234 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003235 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003236 // reference*.
3237 //
3238 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3239 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3240 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3241 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3242 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003243 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3244 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3245 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003246
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003247 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3248 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3249 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3250 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3251}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003252
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003253/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3254/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3255/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003256static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3257CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3258 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3259 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003260{
3261 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3262 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3263
3264 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3265 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3266 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3267 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3268 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003269 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003270 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003271 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003272
3273 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3274 // defined below), or, if not that,
3275 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3276 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3277 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3278 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3279 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3280 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003281
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003282 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3283 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3284 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003285
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003286 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3287 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3288 // that is such a conversion.
3289 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3290 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3291 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3292 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3293
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003294 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3295 //
3296 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003297 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3298 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3299 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003300 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003301 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003302 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003303 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003304 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3305 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3306 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003307 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3308 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003309 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3310 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3311 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003312 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003313 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003314 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003315 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3316 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003317 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3318 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3319 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003320 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3321 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003322
3323 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3324 // conversion, if we need to.
3325 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003326 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003327 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003328 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003329
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003330 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3331 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003332
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003333 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003334 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003335 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003336 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3337
3338 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3339 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003340 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3341 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3342 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3343 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3344 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3345 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3346 FromObjCPtr2);
3347 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3348 FromObjCPtr1);
3349 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3350 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3351 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3352 }
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003353 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003354 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003355
3356 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3357 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003358 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003359 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003360 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003361
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003362 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003363 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3364 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3365 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3366 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3367 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003368
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003369 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3370 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3371 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3372 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3373 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3374 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003375 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3376 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003377 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3378 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003379 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003380 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3381 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003382 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003383 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3384 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3385 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3386 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3387 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3388 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3389 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3390 }
3391
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003392 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3393 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003394 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003395 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003396 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003397 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003398 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3399 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3400 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003401 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003402 }
3403 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003404
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003405 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3406 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3407 // is between types of the same size.
3408 // For example:
3409 // void f(float);
3410 // void f(int);
3411 // int main {
3412 // long a;
3413 // f(a);
3414 // }
3415 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3416 // as clang will do in standard mode.
3417 if (S.getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode &&
3418 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3419 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3420 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3421 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3422 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3423
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003424 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3425}
3426
3427/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3428/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003429/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3430ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003431CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3432 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3433 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003434 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003435 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3436 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3437 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3438 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3439 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3440 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3441 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3442 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3443
3444 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3445 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003446 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3447 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003448 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3449 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003450 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003451 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3452 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003453
3454 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3455 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003456 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003457 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3458
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003459 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3460 // for comparison.
3461 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003462 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003463 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003464 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003465
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003466 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003467 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003468
3469 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3470 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3471 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3472 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3473 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3474 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3475 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3476 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3477 }
3478
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003479 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003480 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3481 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3482 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003483 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003484 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3485 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3486 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3487 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3488 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3489 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3490 // about how the sequences rank.
3491 ;
3492 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3493 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3494 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3495 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3496 // qualifiers.
3497 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003498
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003499 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3500 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3501 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3502 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3503 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3504 // qualifiers.
3505 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003506
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003507 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3508 } else {
3509 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3510 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3511 }
3512
3513 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003514 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003515 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003516 }
3517
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003518 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3519 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3520 switch (Result) {
3521 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003522 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003523 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3524 break;
3525
3526 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3527 break;
3528
3529 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003530 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003531 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3532 break;
3533 }
3534
3535 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003536}
3537
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003538/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3539/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003540/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3541/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3542/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003543ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003544CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3545 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3546 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003547 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003548 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003549 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003550 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003551
3552 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3553 // conversion, if we need to.
3554 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003555 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003556 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003557 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003558
3559 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003560 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3561 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3562 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3563 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003564
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003565 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003566 //
3567 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3568 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003569 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003570 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003571 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003572 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3573 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3574 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3575 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003576 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003577 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003578 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003579 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003580 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003581 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003582 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003583 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003584
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003585 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003586 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003587 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003588 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003589 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003590 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3591 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003592
3593 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3594 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003595 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003596 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003597 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003598 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003599 }
3600 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3601 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3602 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3603 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3604 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3605 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3606 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3607 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3608 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3609 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3610
3611 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3612 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3613 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3614 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3615 // Objective-C pointer types.
3616 bool FromAssignLeft
3617 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3618 bool FromAssignRight
3619 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3620 bool ToAssignLeft
3621 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3622 bool ToAssignRight
3623 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3624
3625 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3626 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3627 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3628 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3629 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3630 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3631 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3632 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3633
3634 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3635 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3636 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3637 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3638 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3639 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3640
3641 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3642 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3643 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3644 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3645 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3646 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3647 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3648 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3649
3650 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3651 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3652 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3653 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3654 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3655 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003656
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003657 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3658 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3659 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3660 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3661 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3662 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3663
3664 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3665 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3666 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3667 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3668 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003669 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003670 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003671
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003672 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003673 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3674 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3675 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003676 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003677 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003678 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003679 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003680 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003681 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003682 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003683 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3684 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3685 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3686 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3687 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3688 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3689 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3690 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3691 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003692 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003693 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003694 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003695 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003696 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003697 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3698 }
3699 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3700 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003701 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003702 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003703 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003704 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3705 }
3706 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003707
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003708 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003709 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003710 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3711 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3712 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003713 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3714 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3715 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003716 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003717 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003718 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3719 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003720
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003721 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003722 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3723 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3724 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003725 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3726 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3727 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003728 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003729 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003730 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3731 }
3732 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003733
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003734 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3735}
3736
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003737/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3738/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3739/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3740/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3741/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3742/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3743/// type being initialized.
3744Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3745Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3746 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003747 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003748 bool &ObjCConversion,
3749 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003750 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3751 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3752 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3753
3754 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3755 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3756 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3757 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3758 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3759
3760 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3761 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3762 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3763 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003764 DerivedToBase = false;
3765 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003766 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003767 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3768 // Nothing to do.
3769 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003770 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3771 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003772 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3773 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3774 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3775 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003776 else
3777 return Ref_Incompatible;
3778
3779 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3780 // least).
3781
3782 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3783 // for comparison.
3784 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3785 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3786 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3787 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3788
3789 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3790 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3791 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3792 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3793 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3794 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3795 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003796 //
3797 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3798 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3799 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3800 // space 2.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003801 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3802 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3803 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3804 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3805 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3806 }
3807
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003808 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003809 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003810 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003811 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3812 else
3813 return Ref_Related;
3814}
3815
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003816/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003817/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3818static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003819FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3820 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3821 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3822 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003823 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3824 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3825 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3826
3827 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3828 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3829 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3830 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3831 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3832 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3833 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3834 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3835 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3836
3837 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3838 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3839 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3840 if (ConvTemplate)
3841 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3842 else
3843 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3844
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003845 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003846 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3847 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3848 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003849
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003850 if (AllowRvalues) {
3851 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3852 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003853 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00003854
3855 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
3856 // functions that return lvalues.
3857 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
3858 const ReferenceType *RefType
3859 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
3860 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
3861 continue;
3862 }
3863
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003864 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003865 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3866 DeclLoc,
3867 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3868 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3869 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003870 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003871 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003872 continue;
3873 } else {
3874 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3875 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3876 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3877
3878 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3879 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3880 if (!RefType ||
3881 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3882 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3883 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003884 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003885
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003886 if (ConvTemplate)
3887 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003888 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003889 else
3890 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003891 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003892 }
3893
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003894 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3895
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003896 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003897 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003898 case OR_Success:
3899 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3900 //
3901 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3902 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3903 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3904 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3905 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3906 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3907 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3908 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3909 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3910 return false;
3911
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003912 if (Best->Function)
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00003913 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003914 ICS.setUserDefined();
3915 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3916 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003917 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003918 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003919 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003920 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3921 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3922 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3923 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3924 return true;
3925
3926 case OR_Ambiguous:
3927 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3928 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3929 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3930 if (Cand->Viable)
3931 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3932 return true;
3933
3934 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3935 case OR_Deleted:
3936 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3937 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3938 return false;
3939 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003940
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003941 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003942}
3943
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003944/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3945/// initialization.
3946static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00003947TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003948 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3949 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003950 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003951 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3952
3953 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3954 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3955 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3956
3957 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3958 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3959
3960 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3961 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3962 // type of the resulting function.
3963 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3964 DeclAccessPair Found;
3965 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3966 false, Found))
3967 T2 = Fn->getType();
3968 }
3969
3970 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3971 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3972 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003973 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003974 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003975 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003976 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003977 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003978 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003979
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003980
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003981 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003982 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3983 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3984
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003985 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003986 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003987 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3988 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3989 //
3990 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3991 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3992 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003993 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003994 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3995 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3996 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3997 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3998 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3999 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4000 ICS.setStandard();
4001 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004002 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4003 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4004 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004005 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4006 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4007 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4008 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4009 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4010 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4011 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004012 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4013 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4014 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004015 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004016 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004017 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004018
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004019 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4020 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4021 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4022 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004023 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004024 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004025
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004026 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4027 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4028 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4029 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4030 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4031 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4032 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4033 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004034 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004035 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004036 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4037 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4038 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004039 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004040 }
4041 }
4042
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004043 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4044 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004045 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004046 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004047 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4048 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4049 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4050 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4051 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4052 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4053 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004054 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4055 // go together.
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004056 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004057 return ICS;
4058
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004059 // -- If the initializer expression
4060 //
4061 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004062 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004063 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4064 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4065 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4066 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4067 ICS.setStandard();
4068 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004069 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004070 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4071 : ICK_Identity;
4072 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4073 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4074 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4075 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4076 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4077 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4078 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4079 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4080 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4081 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4082 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004083 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
4084 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004085 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004086 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4087 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004088 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004089 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004090 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004091 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004092 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004093 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004094
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004095 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4096 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004097 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4098 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004099 // "cv3 T3",
4100 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004101 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004102 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004103 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004104 // class subobject).
4105 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004106 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004107 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4108 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4109 AllowExplicit)) {
4110 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4111 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4112 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4113 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004114 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004115 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4116 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4117
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004118 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004119 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004120
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004121 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4122 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4123 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4124 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4125 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4126 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4127 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4128 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4129 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4130 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4131 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4132 // initialization fails.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004133 //
4134 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4135 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4136 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4137 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4138 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4139 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4140 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4141 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4142 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4143 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004144 }
4145
4146 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4147 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4148 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4149 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4150 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4151 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4152 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4153 return ICS;
4154
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004155 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4156 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4157 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4158 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4159 return ICS;
4160
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004161 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004162 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4163 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4164 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4165 // underlying type of the reference according to
4166 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4167 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4168 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4169 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4170 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004171 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4172 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004173 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004174 /*CStyle=*/false,
4175 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004176
4177 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4178 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4179 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004180 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4181 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4182 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004183 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004184 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004185 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004186 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4187 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4188 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4189 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4190 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4191 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4192 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4193 DeclType);
4194 return ICS;
4195 }
4196 }
4197 }
4198
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004199 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor3ec79102011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004200 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4201 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4202 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4203 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4204 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004205 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004206
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004207 return ICS;
4208}
4209
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004210static ImplicitConversionSequence
4211TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4212 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4213 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004214 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4215 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004216
4217/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4218/// initializer list From.
4219static ImplicitConversionSequence
4220TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4221 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4222 bool InOverloadResolution,
4223 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4224 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4225 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4226 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4227
4228 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4229 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004230 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004231
Sebastian Redl09edce02012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004232 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004233 // initialized from init lists.
4234 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag()))
4235 return Result;
4236
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004237 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4238 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4239 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4240 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4241 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004242 QualType X;
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004243 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004244 X = S.Context.getBaseElementType(ToType);
4245 else
4246 (void)S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
4247 if (!X.isNull()) {
4248 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4249 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4250 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4251 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4252 InOverloadResolution,
4253 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4254 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4255 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4256 Result = ICS;
4257 break;
4258 }
4259 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4260 if (Result.isBad() ||
4261 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4262 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4263 Result = ICS;
4264 }
4265 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004266 return Result;
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004267 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004268
4269 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4270 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4271 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4272 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4273 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4274 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004275 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4276 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4277 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4278 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4279 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4280 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4281 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004282 return Result;
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004283 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004284
4285 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4286 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4287 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4288 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004289 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004290 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4291 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4292 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4293 InitializedEntity Entity =
4294 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4295 /*Consumed=*/false);
4296 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4297 Result.setUserDefined();
4298 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4299 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4300 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4301 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4302
4303 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4304 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4305 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramerb6d65082012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004306 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004307 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004308 return Result;
4309 }
4310
4311 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4312 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004313 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4314 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4315 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4316 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4317
4318 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4319
4320 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4321 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4322 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4323 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4324
4325 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4326
4327 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4328 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4329 // type of the resulting function.
4330 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4331 DeclAccessPair Found;
4332 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4333 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4334 T2 = Fn->getType();
4335 }
4336
4337 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4338 bool dummy1 = false;
4339 bool dummy2 = false;
4340 bool dummy3 = false;
4341 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4342 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4343 dummy2, dummy3);
4344
4345 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4346 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4347 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4348 SuppressUserConversions,
4349 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4350 }
4351
4352 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4353 // initializer list.
4354 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4355 InOverloadResolution,
4356 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4357 if (Result.isFailure())
4358 return Result;
4359 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4360 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4361
4362 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4363 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4364 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4365 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4366 Result.UserDefined.After;
4367 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4368 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4369 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4370 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4371 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4372 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4373 } else
4374 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4375 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004376 return Result;
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004377 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004378
4379 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4380 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4381 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4382 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4383 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4384 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004385 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4386 if (NumInits == 1)
4387 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4388 SuppressUserConversions,
4389 InOverloadResolution,
4390 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4391 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4392 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4393 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4394 Result.setStandard();
4395 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4396 }
4397 return Result;
4398 }
4399
4400 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4401 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4402 return Result;
4403}
4404
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004405/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4406/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4407/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4408/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004409/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004410/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004411static ImplicitConversionSequence
4412TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004413 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004414 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004415 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4416 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004417 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4418 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4419 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4420
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004421 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004422 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004423 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4424 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004425 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004426
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004427 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4428 SuppressUserConversions,
4429 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004430 InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004431 /*CStyle=*/false,
4432 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004433}
4434
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004435static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4436 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4437 Sema &S,
4438 SourceLocation Loc,
4439 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4440 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4441 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4442 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4443
4444 return !ICS.isBad();
4445}
4446
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004447/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4448/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4449/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004450static ImplicitConversionSequence
4451TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004452 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004453 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4454 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4455 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004456 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4457 // const volatile object.
4458 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4459 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004460 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004461
4462 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4463 // to exit early.
4464 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004465
4466 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00004467 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004468 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004469 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4470
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004471 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4472 // better have an lvalue.
4473 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4474 }
4475
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004476 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004477
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004478 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004479 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004480 // parameter is
4481 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004482 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4483 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4484 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004485 // ref-qualifier
4486 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004487 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004488 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4489 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004490 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004491 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004492 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4493 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4494 // non-constant references.
4495
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004496 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004497 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004498 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004499 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004500 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004501 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
4502 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004503 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004504 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004505
4506 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4507 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004508 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004509 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4510 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4511 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004512 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004513 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004514 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004515 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4516 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004517 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004518 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004519
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004520 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4521 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4522 case RQ_None:
4523 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4524 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004525
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004526 case RQ_LValue:
4527 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4528 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004529 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004530 ImplicitParamType);
4531 return ICS;
4532 }
4533 break;
4534
4535 case RQ_RValue:
4536 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4537 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004538 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004539 ImplicitParamType);
4540 return ICS;
4541 }
4542 break;
4543 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004544
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004545 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004546 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004547 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4548 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004549 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004550 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004551 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4552 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004553 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004554 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004555 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4556 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4557 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004558 return ICS;
4559}
4560
4561/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4562/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4563/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004564ExprResult
4565Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004566 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004567 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004568 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004569 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004570 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004571 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004572
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004573 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004574 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004575 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4576 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004577 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004578 } else {
4579 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4580 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004581 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004582 }
4583
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004584 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4585 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004586 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004587 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4588 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004589 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4590 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4591 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4592 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4593 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4594 if (CVR) {
4595 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4596 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4597 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4598 << From->getSourceRange();
4599 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4600 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004601 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004602 }
4603 }
4604
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004605 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004606 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004607 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004608 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004609
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004610 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4611 ExprResult FromRes =
4612 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4613 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4614 return ExprError();
4615 From = FromRes.take();
4616 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004617
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004618 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004619 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smith4a905b62011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004620 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004621 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004622}
4623
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004624/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4625/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004626static ImplicitConversionSequence
4627TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004628 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004629 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004630 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4631 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004632 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004633 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004634 /*CStyle=*/false,
4635 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004636}
4637
4638/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4639/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004640ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004641 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4642 return ExprError();
4643
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004644 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004645 if (!ICS.isBad())
4646 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004647
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004648 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004649 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4650 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004651 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004652 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004653}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004654
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004655/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4656/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4657/// is acceptable.
4658static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4659 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4660 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4661 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4662 // conversions are fine.
4663 switch (SCS.Second) {
4664 case ICK_Identity:
4665 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4666 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
4667 return true;
4668
4669 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
4670 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4671 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4672 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4673 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4674 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4675
4676 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4677 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4678 return false;
4679
4680 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4681 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4682 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4683 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4684 case ICK_Qualification:
4685 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4686 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4687 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4688 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4689 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4690 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4691 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4692 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4693 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4694 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4695 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4696 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4697 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4698 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4699
4700 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4701 break;
4702 }
4703
4704 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4705}
4706
4707/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4708/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4709/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4710ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4711 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4712 CCEKind CCE) {
4713 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus0x && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
4714 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4715
4716 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4717 return ExprError();
4718
4719 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4720 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4721 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4722 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4723 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4724 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4725 // narrowing conversions.
4726 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4727 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4728 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4729 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4730 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4731 /*CStyle=*/false,
4732 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4733 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4734 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4735 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4736 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
4737 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4738 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4739 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4740 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4741 break;
4742 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4743 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4744 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4745 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
4746 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4747 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4748 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4749 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4750 break;
4751 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4752 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4753 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
4754 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4755 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4756 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4757 return ExprError();
4758
4759 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4760 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4761 }
4762
4763 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4764 if (Result.isInvalid())
4765 return Result;
4766
4767 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4768 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004769 bool Diagnosed = false;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004770 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue)) {
4771 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4772 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4773 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4774 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4775 break;
4776
4777 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
4778 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_cce_narrowing)
4779 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
4780 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, QualType()) << T;
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004781 Diagnosed = true;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004782 break;
4783
4784 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
4785 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_cce_narrowing)
4786 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004787 Diagnosed = true;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004788 break;
4789 }
4790
4791 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
4792 llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
4793 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
4794 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
4795
4796 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) {
4797 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
4798 // the AST.
4799 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004800 } else {
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004801 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004802
4803 if (Notes.empty()) {
4804 // It's a constant expression.
4805 return Result;
4806 }
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004807 }
4808
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004809 // Only issue one narrowing diagnostic.
4810 if (Diagnosed)
4811 return Result;
4812
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004813 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
4814 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
4815 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
4816 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
4817 else {
4818 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
4819 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
4820 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
4821 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
4822 }
Richard Smith911e1422012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004823 return Result;
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004824}
4825
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004826/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
4827/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
4828/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
4829static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4830 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4831 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
4832 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
4833 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
4834 }
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004835}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004836
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004837/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
4838/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4839static ImplicitConversionSequence
4840TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
4841 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
4842 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
4843 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
4844 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
4845 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4846 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4847 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
4848 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4849 /*CStyle=*/false,
4850 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
4851
4852 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
4853 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4854 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4855 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4856 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4857 break;
4858
4859 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4860 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
4861 break;
4862
4863 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4864 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
4865 break;
4866 }
4867
4868 return ICS;
4869}
4870
4871/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
4872/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4873ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004874 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4875 return ExprError();
4876
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004877 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004878 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4879 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004880 if (!ICS.isBad())
4881 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004882 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004883}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004884
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004885/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
4886/// type of a permitted flavor.
4887static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) {
4888 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
4889 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
4890}
4891
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004892/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004893/// enumeration type.
4894///
4895/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
4896/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
4897/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4898///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004899/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
4900/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004901///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004902/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
4903///
4904/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
4905/// have integral or enumeration type.
4906///
4907/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
4908/// incomplete class type.
4909///
4910/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
4911/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
4912/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
4913///
4914/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
4915/// showing which conversion was picked.
4916///
4917/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
4918/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
4919///
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004920/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004921/// usable conversion function.
4922///
4923/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
4924/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
4925///
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004926/// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped
4927/// enumerations should be considered.
4928///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004929/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
4930/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004931ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004932Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004933 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
4934 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
4935 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
4936 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
4937 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004938 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004939 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag,
4940 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004941 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
4942 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004943 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004944
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00004945 // Process placeholders immediately.
4946 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
4947 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
4948 if (result.isInvalid()) return result;
4949 From = result.take();
4950 }
4951
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004952 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
4953 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004954 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations))
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00004955 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004956
4957 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
4958
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004959 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004960 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
4961 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
4962 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Richard Smithf4c51d92012-02-04 09:53:13 +00004963 if (NotIntDiag.getDiagID())
4964 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag) << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004965 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004966 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004967
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004968 // We must have a complete class type.
4969 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004970 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004971
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004972 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4973 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
4974 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
4975 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4976 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004977
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004978 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (Conversions->size() > 1);
4979
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004980 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004981 E = Conversions->end();
4982 I != E;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004983 ++I) {
4984 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004985 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) {
4986 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(
4987 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(),
4988 AllowScopedEnumerations)) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004989 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
4990 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
4991 else
4992 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
4993 }
Richard Smith8dd34252012-02-04 07:07:42 +00004994 }
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004995 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004996
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004997 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
4998 case 0:
Richard Smithf4c51d92012-02-04 09:53:13 +00004999 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && ExplicitConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005000 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5001 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5002 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005003
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005004 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5005 // conversion; use it.
5006 QualType ConvTy
5007 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5008 std::string TypeStr;
Douglas Gregor75acd922011-09-27 23:30:47 +00005009 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005010
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005011 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
5012 << T << ConvTy
5013 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5014 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5015 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
5016 ")");
5017 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
5018 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005019
5020 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005021 // explicit conversion function.
5022 if (isSFINAEContext())
5023 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005024
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005025 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005026 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5027 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005028 if (Result.isInvalid())
5029 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005030 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5031 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5032 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5033 Result.get(), 0,
5034 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005035 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005036
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005037 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5038 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005039
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005040 case 1: {
5041 // Apply this conversion.
5042 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5043 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005044
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005045 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5046 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5047 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005048 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005049 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
5050 if (isSFINAEContext())
5051 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005052
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005053 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
5054 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
5055 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005056
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005057 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5058 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005059 if (Result.isInvalid())
5060 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005061 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5062 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5063 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5064 Result.get(), 0,
5065 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005066 break;
5067 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005068
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005069 default:
Richard Smithf4c51d92012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005070 if (!AmbigDiag.getDiagID())
5071 return Owned(From);
5072
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005073 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
5074 << T << From->getSourceRange();
5075 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5076 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
5077 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5078 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5079 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
5080 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
5081 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005082 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005083 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005084
Richard Smithf4c51d92012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005085 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) &&
5086 NotIntDiag.getDiagID())
5087 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag) << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005088
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005089 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005090}
5091
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005092/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005093/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5094/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5095/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005096///
5097/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
5098/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5099/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005100void
5101Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005102 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005103 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005104 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005105 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005106 bool PartialOverloading,
5107 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005108 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005109 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005110 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005111 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005112 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005113
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005114 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005115 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5116 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5117 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5118 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5119 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005120 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5121 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5122 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005123 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005124 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005125 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005126 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005127 return;
5128 }
5129 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5130 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005131 }
5132
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005133 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005134 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005135
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005136 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005137 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005138
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005139 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
5140 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5141 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5142 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5143 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005144 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005145 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005146 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5147 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005148 return;
5149 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005150
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005151 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005152 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005153 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005154 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005155 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005156 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005157 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005158 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005159
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005160 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5161
5162 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5163 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5164 // list (8.3.5).
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005165 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005166 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005167 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005168 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005169 return;
5170 }
5171
5172 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5173 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5174 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5175 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5176 // exactly m parameters.
5177 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005178 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005179 // Not enough arguments.
5180 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005181 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005182 return;
5183 }
5184
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005185 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
5186 if (getLangOptions().CUDA)
5187 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5188 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5189 Candidate.Viable = false;
5190 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5191 return;
5192 }
5193
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005194 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5195 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005196 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5197 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5198 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5199 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5200 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5201 // parameter of F.
5202 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005203 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005204 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005205 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005206 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5207 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
Douglas Gregor6073dca2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005208 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount,
5209 AllowExplicit);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005210 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5211 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005212 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005213 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005214 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005215 } else {
5216 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5217 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5218 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005219 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005220 }
5221 }
5222}
5223
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005224/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5225/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005226void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005227 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5228 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5229 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005230 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005231 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5232 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005233 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005234 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005235 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005236 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005237 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005238 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
5239 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005240 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005241 SuppressUserConversions);
5242 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005243 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005244 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5245 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005246 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005247 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005248 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005249 Args[0]->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005250 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
5251 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005252 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005253 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005254 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005255 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005256 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005257 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
5258 SuppressUserConversions);
5259 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005260 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005261}
5262
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005263/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5264/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005265void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005266 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005267 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005268 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5269 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005270 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005271 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005272 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005273
5274 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5275 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005276
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005277 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5278 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5279 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005280 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5281 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005282 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005283 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005284 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005285 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005286 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005287 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005288 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005289 }
5290}
5291
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005292/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5293/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5294/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5295/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5296/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5297/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005298/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005299void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005300Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005301 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005302 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005303 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005304 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005305 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005306 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005307 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005308 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005309 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5310 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005311
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005312 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5313 return;
5314
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005315 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005316 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005317
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005318 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005319 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005320 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005321 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005322 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005323 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005324 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005325
5326 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5327
5328 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5329 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5330 // list (8.3.5).
5331 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
5332 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005333 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005334 return;
5335 }
5336
5337 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5338 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5339 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5340 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5341 // exactly m parameters.
5342 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
5343 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
5344 // Not enough arguments.
5345 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005346 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005347 return;
5348 }
5349
5350 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005351
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005352 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005353 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5354 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5355 else {
5356 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5357 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005358 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005359 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5360 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005361 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005362 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005363 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005364 return;
5365 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005366 }
5367
5368 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5369 // arguments.
5370 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5371 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5372 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5373 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5374 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5375 // parameter of F.
5376 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005377 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005378 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005379 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005380 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5381 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5382 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005383 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005384 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005385 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005386 break;
5387 }
5388 } else {
5389 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5390 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5391 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005392 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005393 }
5394 }
5395}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005396
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005397/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5398/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5399/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005400void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005401Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005402 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005403 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005404 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005405 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005406 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005407 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005408 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005409 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005410 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5411 return;
5412
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005413 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005414 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005415 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005416 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005417 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5418 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5419 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5420 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5421 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005422 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005423 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5424 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005425 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005426 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005427 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005428 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5429 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5430 Candidate.Viable = false;
5431 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5432 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5433 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005434 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005435 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005436 Info);
5437 return;
5438 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005439
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005440 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5441 // deduction as a candidate.
5442 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005443 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005444 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005445 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005446 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5447 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005448}
5449
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005450/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5451/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5452/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005453void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005454Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005455 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005456 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005457 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5458 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005459 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005460 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5461 return;
5462
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005463 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005464 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005465 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005466 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005467 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5468 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5469 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5470 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5471 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005472 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005473 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5474 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005475 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00005476 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005477 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005478 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005479 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5480 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005481 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005482 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5483 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005484 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005485 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005486 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005487 return;
5488 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005489
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005490 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5491 // deduction as a candidate.
5492 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005493 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005494 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005495}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005496
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005497/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005498/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005499/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005500/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005501/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5502/// conversion function produces).
5503void
5504Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005505 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005506 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005507 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5508 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005509 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5510 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005511 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005512 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5513 return;
5514
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005515 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005516 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005517
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005518 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005519 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005520 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005521 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005522 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005523 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005524 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005525 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005526 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005527 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005528 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005529
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005530 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005531 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5532 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005533 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005534 //
5535 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5536 // object parameter.
5537 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5538 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5539 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5540 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5541 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005542
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005543 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005544 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5545 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005546 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005547
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005548 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005549 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005550 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005551 return;
5552 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005553
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005554 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005555 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5556 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5557 QualType FromCanon
5558 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5559 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5560 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5561 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005562 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005563 return;
5564 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005565
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005566 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5567 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5568 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5569 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5570 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5571 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5572 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5573 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005574 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005575 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005576 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5577 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005578 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005579 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005580
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005581 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5582 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005583 Candidate.Viable = false;
5584 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5585 return;
5586 }
5587
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005588 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005589
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005590 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005591 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5592 // allocator).
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005593 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005594 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005595 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005596 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005597 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005598 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005599 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5600 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005601
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005602 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005603 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5604 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005605
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005606 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5607 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005608 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005609 // shall have exact match rank.
5610 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5611 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5612 Candidate.Viable = false;
5613 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5614 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005615
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005616 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5617 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5618 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5619 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5620 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005621 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005622 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5623 Candidate.Viable = false;
5624 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5625 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005626 break;
5627
5628 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5629 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005630 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005631 break;
5632
5633 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005634 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005635 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5636 }
5637}
5638
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005639/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5640/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5641/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5642/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5643/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005644void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005645Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005646 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005647 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005648 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5649 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5650 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5651 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5652
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005653 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5654 return;
5655
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005656 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005657 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5658 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005659 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005660 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005661 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005662 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5663 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5664 Candidate.Viable = false;
5665 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5666 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5667 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005668 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005669 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005670 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005671 return;
5672 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005673
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005674 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
5675 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
5676 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005677 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005678 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005679}
5680
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005681/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
5682/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
5683/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
5684/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
5685/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
5686void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005687 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005688 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00005689 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005690 Expr *Object,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005691 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005692 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005693 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5694 return;
5695
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005696 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005697 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005698
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005699 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005700 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005701 Candidate.Function = 0;
5702 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
5703 Candidate.Viable = true;
5704 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005705 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005706 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005707
5708 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5709 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005710 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005711 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005712 Object->Classify(Context),
5713 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005714 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005715 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005716 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005717 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005718 return;
5719 }
5720
5721 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
5722 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
5723 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005724 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005725 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00005726 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005727 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005728 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00005729 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005730 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005731 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
5732 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5733
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005734 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005735 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5736
5737 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5738 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5739 // list (8.3.5).
5740 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
5741 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005742 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005743 return;
5744 }
5745
5746 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
5747 // we have enough arguments.
5748 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
5749 // Not enough arguments.
5750 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005751 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005752 return;
5753 }
5754
5755 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5756 // arguments.
5757 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5758 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5759 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5760 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5761 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5762 // parameter of F.
5763 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005764 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005765 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005766 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005767 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5768 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5769 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005770 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005771 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005772 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005773 break;
5774 }
5775 } else {
5776 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5777 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5778 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005779 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005780 }
5781 }
5782}
5783
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005784/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5785/// member functions.
5786///
5787/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
5788/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
5789/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
5790/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
5791/// [over.match.oper]).
5792void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5793 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5794 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5795 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5796 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005797 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
5798
5799 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5800 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
5801 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
5802 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
5803 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
5804 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
5805 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
5806 // constructed as follows:
5807 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005808
5809 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
5810 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
5811 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
5812 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005813 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005814 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00005815 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005816 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005817
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00005818 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
5819 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
5820 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
5821
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005822 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005823 OperEnd = Operators.end();
5824 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005825 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005826 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005827 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005828 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005829 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005830 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005831}
5832
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005833/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
5834/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
5835/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005836/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
5837/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005838/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
5839/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
5840/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005841void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005842 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005843 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005844 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
5845 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005846 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005847 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005848
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005849 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005850 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005851 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005852 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00005853 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005854 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005855 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
5856 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5857 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
5858
5859 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5860 // arguments.
5861 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005862 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005863 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005864 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
5865 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
5866 // left operand are restricted as follows:
5867 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
5868 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
5869 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005870 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005871 //
5872 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
5873 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
5874 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
5875 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005876 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005877 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005878 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005879 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
5880 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005881 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005882 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005883 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005884 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005885 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5886 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5887 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005888 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005889 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005890 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005891 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005892 break;
5893 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005894 }
5895}
5896
5897/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
5898/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
5899/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
5900/// enumeration types.
5901class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
5902 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005903 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005904
5905 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
5906 /// built-in candidates.
5907 TypeSet PointerTypes;
5908
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005909 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
5910 /// used in the built-in candidates.
5911 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
5912
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005913 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
5914 /// used in the built-in candidates.
5915 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
5916
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005917 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005918 /// candidates.
5919 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005920
5921 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
5922 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
5923
5924 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
5925 /// were present in the candidate set.
5926 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
5927
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005928 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
5929 /// candidate set.
5930 bool HasNullPtrType;
5931
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00005932 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
5933 /// candidate type set.
5934 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005935
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005936 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
5937 ASTContext &Context;
5938
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005939 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
5940 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005941 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005942
5943public:
5944 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005945 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005946
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005947 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005948 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
5949 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005950 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005951 SemaRef(SemaRef),
5952 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005953
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005954 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005955 SourceLocation Loc,
5956 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005957 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
5958 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005959
5960 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
5961 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
5962
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005963 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005964 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
5965
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005966 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
5967 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
5968
5969 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
5970 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
5971
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005972 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
5973 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
5974
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005975 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005976 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005977
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005978 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
5979 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005980
5981 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
5982 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005983 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005984};
5985
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005986/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005987/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5988/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5989/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5990/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5991/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5992/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005993///
5994/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005995bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005996BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
5997 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005998
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005999 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006000 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006001 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006002
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006003 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006004 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006005 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006006 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006007 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006008 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006009 buildObjCPtr = true;
6010 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006011 else
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006012 llvm_unreachable("type was not a pointer type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006013 }
6014 else
6015 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006016
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006017 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6018 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6019 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6020 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6021 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6022 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006023 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00006024 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00006025 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006026 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6027 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006028
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006029 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6030 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6031 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006032 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
6033 // in the types.
6034 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
6035 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006036 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006037 if (!buildObjCPtr)
6038 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
6039 else
6040 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006041 }
6042
6043 return true;
6044}
6045
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006046/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6047/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6048/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6049/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6050/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6051/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6052/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006053///
6054/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006055bool
6056BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6057 QualType Ty) {
6058 // Insert this type.
6059 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6060 return false;
6061
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006062 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6063 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006064
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006065 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006066 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6067 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6068 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6069 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6070 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6071 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006072 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6073
6074 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6075 // qualifiers.
6076 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6077 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6078 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006079
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006080 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006081 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6082 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006083 }
6084
6085 return true;
6086}
6087
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006088/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6089/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006090/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6091/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006092/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6093/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6094/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6095/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006096void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006097BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006098 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006099 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006100 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6101 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006102 // Only deal with canonical types.
6103 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6104
6105 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6106 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006107 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006108 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6109
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006110 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6111 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6112 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6113
6114 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006115 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006116
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006117 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6118 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6119 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6120
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006121 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6122 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6123 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6124
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006125 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6126 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6127 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006128 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6129 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006130 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006131 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006132 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6133 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6134 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6135 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006136 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006137 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006138 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006139 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006140 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6141 // extension.
6142 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006143 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006144 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6145 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006146 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6147 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6148 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6149 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006150
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006151 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
6152 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
6153 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6154 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
6155 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
6156 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6157 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6158 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006159
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006160 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6161 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6162 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6163 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006164
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006165 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6166 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6167 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6168 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006169 }
6170 }
6171 }
6172}
6173
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006174/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6175/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6176/// given type to the candidate set.
6177static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6178 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006179 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006180 unsigned NumArgs,
6181 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6182 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006183
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006184 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6185 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6186 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6187 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6188 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006189
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006190 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6191 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006192 ParamTypes[0]
6193 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006194 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6195 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006196 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006197 }
6198}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006199
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006200/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6201/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006202static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6203 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6204 const RecordType *TyRec;
6205 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6206 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006207 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006208 else
6209 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6210 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006211 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006212 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6213 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6214 return VRQuals;
6215 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006216
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006217 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006218 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6219 return VRQuals;
6220
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006221 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006222 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006223
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006224 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006225 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006226 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6227 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6228 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6229 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006230 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6231 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6232 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6233 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6234 // as see them.
6235 bool done = false;
6236 while (!done) {
6237 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6238 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006239 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006240 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6241 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6242 else
6243 done = true;
6244 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6245 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6246 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6247 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6248 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6249 return VRQuals;
6250 }
6251 }
6252 }
6253 return VRQuals;
6254}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006255
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006256namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006257
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006258/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6259/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6260/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6261/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6262class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006263 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6264 Sema &S;
6265 Expr **Args;
6266 unsigned NumArgs;
6267 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006268 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006269 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006270 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006271
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006272 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6273 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006274 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6275 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006276 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
6277 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
6278 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
6279 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
6280 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
6281 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
6282 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
6283
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006284 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6285 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6286 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6287 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6288 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6289 // Start of promoted types.
6290 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6291 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6292 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006293
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006294 // Start of integral types.
6295 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6296 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6297 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
6298 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6299 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6300 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
6301 // End of promoted types.
6302
6303 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6304 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6305 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6306 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6307 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6308 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6309 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6310 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6311 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6312 // End of integral types.
6313 // FIXME: What about complex?
6314 };
6315 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6316 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006317
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006318 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6319 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6320 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6321 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6322 // The rules are basically:
6323 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6324 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6325 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6326 // - use the larger type
6327 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6328 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6329 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6330 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6331 // better not to make any assumptions).
6332 enum PromotedType {
6333 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
6334 };
6335 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
6336 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
6337 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6338 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6339 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6340 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
6341 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
6342 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
6343 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
6344 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
6345 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
6346 };
6347
6348 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6349 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6350 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6351
6352 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006353 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006354
6355 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6356 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006357 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6358 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006359 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6360 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6361
6362 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6363 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6364 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6365
6366 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6367 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6368 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6369 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6370 }
6371
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006372 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6373 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006374 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
6375 bool HasVolatile) {
6376 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6377 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6378 S.Context.IntTy
6379 };
6380
6381 // Non-volatile version.
6382 if (NumArgs == 1)
6383 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6384 else
6385 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6386
6387 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6388 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6389 if (HasVolatile) {
6390 ParamTypes[0] =
6391 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6392 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
6393 if (NumArgs == 1)
6394 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6395 else
6396 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6397 }
6398 }
6399
6400public:
6401 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
6402 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6403 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006404 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006405 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006406 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
6407 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
6408 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006409 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6410 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006411 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6412 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6413 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006414 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006415 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006416 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
6417 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006418 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006419 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6420 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006421 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006422 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
6423 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006424 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6425 }
6426
6427 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6428 //
6429 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6430 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6431 // functions of the form
6432 //
6433 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6434 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6435 //
6436 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6437 //
6438 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6439 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6440 // candidate operator functions of the form
6441 //
6442 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6443 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6444 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006445 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6446 return;
6447
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006448 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6449 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6450 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006451 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006452 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
6453 }
6454 }
6455
6456 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6457 //
6458 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6459 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6460 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6461 //
6462 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6463 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6464 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6465 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6466 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6467 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6468 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6469 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6470 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6471 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006472 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006473 continue;
6474
6475 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
6476 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6477 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
6478 }
6479 }
6480
6481 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6482 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6483 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6484 //
6485 // T& operator*(T*);
6486 //
6487 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006488 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006489 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006490 // T& operator*(T*);
6491 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6492 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6493 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6494 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6495 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6496 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6497 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006498 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6499 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006500
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006501 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6502 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6503 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006504
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006505 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
6506 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6507 }
6508 }
6509
6510 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6511 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6512 // operator functions of the form
6513 //
6514 // T operator+(T);
6515 // T operator-(T);
6516 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006517 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6518 return;
6519
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006520 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6521 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006522 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006523 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6524 }
6525
6526 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6527 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6528 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6529 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6530 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6531 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6532 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6533 }
6534 }
6535
6536 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6537 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6538 // the form
6539 //
6540 // T* operator+(T*);
6541 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6542 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6543 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6544 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6545 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6546 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6547 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6548 }
6549 }
6550
6551 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6552 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6553 // operator functions of the form
6554 //
6555 // T operator~(T);
6556 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006557 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6558 return;
6559
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006560 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6561 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006562 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006563 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6564 }
6565
6566 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6567 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6568 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6569 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6570 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6571 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6572 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6573 }
6574 }
6575
6576 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6577 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6578 // functions of the form
6579 //
6580 // bool operator==(T,T);
6581 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6582 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6583 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6584 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6585
6586 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6587 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6588 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6589 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6590 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6591 ++MemPtr) {
6592 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6593 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6594 continue;
6595
6596 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6597 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6598 CandidateSet);
6599 }
6600 }
6601 }
6602
6603 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6604 //
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006605 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6606 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006607 //
6608 // bool operator<(T, T);
6609 // bool operator>(T, T);
6610 // bool operator<=(T, T);
6611 // bool operator>=(T, T);
6612 // bool operator==(T, T);
6613 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006614 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
6615 // C++ [over.built]p1:
6616 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
6617 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
6618 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
6619 // functions.
6620 //
6621 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
6622 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
6623 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
6624 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
6625 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
6626 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
6627 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
6628 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
6629 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
6630
6631 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6632 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
6633 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
6634 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
6635 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6636 C != CEnd; ++C) {
6637 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
6638 continue;
6639
6640 QualType FirstParamType =
6641 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6642 QualType SecondParamType =
6643 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6644
6645 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
6646 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
6647 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
6648 continue;
6649
6650 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
6651 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
6652 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
6653 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
6654 }
6655 }
6656 }
6657
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006658 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6659 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6660
6661 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6662 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6663 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6664 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6665 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6666 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6667 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6668 continue;
6669
6670 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6671 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6672 CandidateSet);
6673 }
6674 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6675 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6676 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6677 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6678 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
6679
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006680 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
6681 // candidate exists.
6682 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
6683 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
6684 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006685 continue;
6686
6687 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006688 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6689 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006690 }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006691
6692 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
6693 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
6694 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
6695 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
6696 NullPtrTy))) {
6697 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
6698 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6699 CandidateSet);
6700 }
6701 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006702 }
6703 }
6704
6705 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6706 //
6707 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
6708 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6709 //
6710 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6711 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
6712 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6713 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6714 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
6715 //
6716 // C++ [over.built]p14:
6717 //
6718 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
6719 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6720 //
6721 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6722 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6723 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6724 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6725
6726 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
6727 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
6728 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6729 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6730 };
6731 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6732 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
6733 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
6734 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006735 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6736 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
6737 continue;
6738
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006739 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
6740 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
6741 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
6742 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6743 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
6744 CandidateSet);
6745 }
6746 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
6747 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6748 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6749 continue;
6750
6751 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6752 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
6753 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6754 }
6755 }
6756 }
6757 }
6758
6759 // C++ [over.built]p12:
6760 //
6761 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
6762 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6763 //
6764 // LR operator*(L, R);
6765 // LR operator/(L, R);
6766 // LR operator+(L, R);
6767 // LR operator-(L, R);
6768 // bool operator<(L, R);
6769 // bool operator>(L, R);
6770 // bool operator<=(L, R);
6771 // bool operator>=(L, R);
6772 // bool operator==(L, R);
6773 // bool operator!=(L, R);
6774 //
6775 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6776 // between types L and R.
6777 //
6778 // C++ [over.built]p24:
6779 //
6780 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
6781 // candidate operator functions of the form
6782 //
6783 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
6784 //
6785 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6786 // between types L and R.
6787 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
6788 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006789 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6790 return;
6791
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006792 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6793 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
6794 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6795 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006796 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6797 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006798 QualType Result =
6799 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006800 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006801 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6802 }
6803 }
6804
6805 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
6806 // conditional operator for vector types.
6807 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6808 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6809 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6810 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
6811 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6812 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
6813 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
6814 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
6815 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
6816 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
6817 if (!isComparison) {
6818 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
6819 Result = *Vec1;
6820 else
6821 Result = *Vec2;
6822 }
6823
6824 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6825 }
6826 }
6827 }
6828
6829 // C++ [over.built]p17:
6830 //
6831 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
6832 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6833 //
6834 // LR operator%(L, R);
6835 // LR operator&(L, R);
6836 // LR operator^(L, R);
6837 // LR operator|(L, R);
6838 // L operator<<(L, R);
6839 // L operator>>(L, R);
6840 //
6841 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6842 // between types L and R.
6843 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006844 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6845 return;
6846
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006847 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6848 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
6849 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6850 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006851 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6852 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006853 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
6854 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006855 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006856 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6857 }
6858 }
6859 }
6860
6861 // C++ [over.built]p20:
6862 //
6863 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
6864 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
6865 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6866 //
6867 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
6868 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
6869 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6870 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6871
6872 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
6873 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6874 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6875 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6876 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6877 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
6878 continue;
6879
6880 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
6881 CandidateSet);
6882 }
6883
6884 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6885 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6886 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6887 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6888 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6889 continue;
6890
6891 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
6892 CandidateSet);
6893 }
6894 }
6895 }
6896
6897 // C++ [over.built]p19:
6898 //
6899 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
6900 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
6901 // of the form
6902 //
6903 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
6904 //
6905 // C++ [over.built]p21:
6906 //
6907 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6908 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
6909 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6910 //
6911 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
6912 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
6913 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
6914 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6915 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6916
6917 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6918 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6919 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6920 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6921 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
6922 if (isEqualOp)
6923 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006924 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
6925 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006926
6927 // non-volatile version
6928 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6929 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
6930 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6931 };
6932 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6933 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
6934
6935 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6936 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6937 // volatile version
6938 ParamTypes[0] =
6939 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
6940 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6941 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6942 }
6943 }
6944
6945 if (isEqualOp) {
6946 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6947 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
6948 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
6949 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6950 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
6951 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6952 continue;
6953
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006954 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6955 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
6956 *Ptr,
6957 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006958
6959 // non-volatile version
6960 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6961 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
6962
6963 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6964 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6965 // volatile version
6966 ParamTypes[0] =
6967 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006968 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6969 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006970 }
6971 }
6972 }
6973 }
6974
6975 // C++ [over.built]p18:
6976 //
6977 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
6978 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
6979 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
6980 // the form
6981 //
6982 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
6983 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
6984 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
6985 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
6986 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
6987 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006988 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6989 return;
6990
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006991 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
6992 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6993 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
6994 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006995 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006996
6997 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6998 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006999 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007000 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7001 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7002
7003 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7004 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7005 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007006 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007007 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007008 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7009 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007010 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7011 }
7012 }
7013 }
7014
7015 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7016 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7017 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7018 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7019 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7020 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7021 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7022 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7023 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7024 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7025 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7026 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7027 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7028 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7029 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7030
7031 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7032 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7033 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7034 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007035 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7036 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007037 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7038 }
7039 }
7040 }
7041 }
7042
7043 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7044 //
7045 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7046 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7047 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7048 //
7049 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7050 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7051 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7052 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7053 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7054 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7055 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007056 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7057 return;
7058
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007059 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7060 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7061 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7062 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007063 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007064
7065 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7066 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007067 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007068 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7069 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7070 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007071 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007072 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7073 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7074 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7075 CandidateSet);
7076 }
7077 }
7078 }
7079 }
7080
7081 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7082 //
7083 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7084 //
7085 // bool operator!(bool);
7086 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7087 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7088 void addExclaimOverload() {
7089 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
7090 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
7091 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7092 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7093 }
7094 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7095 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
7096 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7097 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7098 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7099 }
7100
7101 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7102 //
7103 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7104 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7105 //
7106 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7107 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7108 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7109 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7110 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7111 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7112 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7113 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7114 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7115 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7116 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7117 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007118 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7119 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007120
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007121 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7122
7123 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
7124 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7125 }
7126
7127 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7128 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7129 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7130 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7131 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7132 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007133 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7134 continue;
7135
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007136 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7137
7138 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
7139 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7140 }
7141 }
7142
7143 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7144 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7145 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7146 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7147 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7148 //
7149 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7150 //
7151 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7152 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7153 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7154 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7155 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7156 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7157 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7158 QualType C1;
7159 QualifierCollector Q1;
7160 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7161 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7162 continue;
7163 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7164 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7165 // volatile/restrict type.
7166 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7167 continue;
7168 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7169 continue;
7170 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7171 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7172 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7173 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7174 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7175 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7176 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7177 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7178 break;
7179 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7180 // build CV12 T&
7181 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7182 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7183 T.isVolatileQualified())
7184 continue;
7185 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7186 T.isRestrictQualified())
7187 continue;
7188 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7189 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7190 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7191 }
7192 }
7193 }
7194
7195 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7196 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7197 // therefore added as binary.
7198 //
7199 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7200 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7201 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7202 //
7203 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7204 //
7205 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7206 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7207 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7208
7209 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7210 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7211 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7212 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7213 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7214 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7215 continue;
7216
7217 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7218 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7219 }
7220
7221 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7222 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7223 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7224 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7225 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7226 continue;
7227
7228 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7229 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7230 }
7231
7232 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
7233 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7234 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7235 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7236 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7237 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7238 continue;
7239
7240 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7241 continue;
7242
7243 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7244 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7245 }
7246 }
7247 }
7248 }
7249};
7250
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007251} // end anonymous namespace
7252
7253/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7254/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7255/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7256/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7257/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7258void
7259Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7260 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7261 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7262 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007263 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7264 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007265 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7266 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007267 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7268 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007269 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7270 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007271
7272 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7273 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007274 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007275 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7276 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7277 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7278 OpLoc,
7279 true,
7280 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7281 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7282 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7283 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007284 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7285 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7286 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7287 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7288 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007289 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007290
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007291 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7292 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor877d4eb2011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007293 //
7294 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7295 // 'bool' overloads.
7296 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7297 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007298 return;
7299
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007300 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7301 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
7302 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007303 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007304 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7305
7306 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007307 switch (Op) {
7308 case OO_None:
7309 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007310 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007311
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007312 case OO_New:
7313 case OO_Delete:
7314 case OO_Array_New:
7315 case OO_Array_Delete:
7316 case OO_Call:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007317 llvm_unreachable(
7318 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007319
7320 case OO_Comma:
7321 case OO_Arrow:
7322 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7323 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7324 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007325 break;
7326
7327 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007328 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007329 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007330 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007331
7332 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007333 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007334 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007335 } else {
7336 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7337 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7338 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007339 break;
7340
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007341 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007342 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007343 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7344 else
7345 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7346 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007347
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007348 case OO_Slash:
7349 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007350 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007351
7352 case OO_PlusPlus:
7353 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007354 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7355 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007356 break;
7357
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007358 case OO_EqualEqual:
7359 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007360 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007361 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007362
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007363 case OO_Less:
7364 case OO_Greater:
7365 case OO_LessEqual:
7366 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007367 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007368 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7369 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007370
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007371 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007372 case OO_Caret:
7373 case OO_Pipe:
7374 case OO_LessLess:
7375 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007376 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007377 break;
7378
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007379 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
7380 if (NumArgs == 1)
7381 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7382 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7383 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7384 break;
7385
7386 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7387 break;
7388
7389 case OO_Tilde:
7390 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7391 break;
7392
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007393 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007394 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007395 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007396
7397 case OO_PlusEqual:
7398 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007399 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007400 // Fall through.
7401
7402 case OO_StarEqual:
7403 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007404 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007405 break;
7406
7407 case OO_PercentEqual:
7408 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7409 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7410 case OO_AmpEqual:
7411 case OO_CaretEqual:
7412 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007413 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007414 break;
7415
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007416 case OO_Exclaim:
7417 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007418 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007419
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007420 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007421 case OO_PipePipe:
7422 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007423 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007424
7425 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007426 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007427 break;
7428
7429 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007430 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007431 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007432
7433 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007434 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007435 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7436 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007437 }
7438}
7439
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007440/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7441/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7442///
7443/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7444/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7445/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7446/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007447void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007448Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithe06a2c12012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007449 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007450 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007451 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007452 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007453 bool PartialOverloading,
7454 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007455 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007456
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007457 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7458 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7459 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7460 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7461 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7462 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7463
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007464 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithe06a2c12012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007465 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, NumArgs, Fns,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007466 StdNamespaceIsAssociated);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007467
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007468 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007469 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7470 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7471 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007472 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007473 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007474 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007475 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007476 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007477
7478 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7479 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007480 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007481 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007482 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007483 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007484 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007485
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007486 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00007487 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007488 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007489 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007490 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00007491 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007492 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007493}
7494
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007495/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7496/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007497bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007498isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007499 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7500 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007501 SourceLocation Loc,
7502 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007503 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7504 // functions.
7505 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7506 return Cand1.Viable;
7507 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7508 return false;
7509
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007510 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7511 //
7512 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7513 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7514 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7515 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7516 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7517 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7518 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007519
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007520 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007521 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7522 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007523 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007524 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7525 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007526 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007527 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007528 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7529 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007530 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7531 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7532 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7533 HasBetterConversion = true;
7534 break;
7535
7536 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7537 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7538 return false;
7539
7540 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7541 // Do nothing.
7542 break;
7543 }
7544 }
7545
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007546 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007547 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007548 if (HasBetterConversion)
7549 return true;
7550
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007551 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007552 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007553 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007554 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7555 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007556
7557 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7558 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7559 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007560 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007561 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007562 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007563 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007564 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7565 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7566 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007567 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregorb837ea42011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007568 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007569 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007570 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007571 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007572
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007573 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
7574 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
7575 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
7576 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
7577 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
7578 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007579 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007580 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007581 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregor2837aa22012-02-22 17:32:19 +00007582 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
7583 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
7584 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
7585 // pointer or block.
7586 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
7587 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
7588 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
7589 return FuncResult;
7590
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007591 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
7592 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007593 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
7594 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7595 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7596 return true;
7597
7598 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7599 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7600 return false;
7601
7602 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7603 // Do nothing
7604 break;
7605 }
7606 }
7607
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007608 return false;
7609}
7610
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007611/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007612/// within an overload candidate set.
7613///
7614/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
7615///
7616/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
7617/// which overload resolution occurs.
7618///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007619/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007620/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
7621///
7622/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007623OverloadingResult
7624OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007625 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007626 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007627 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007628 Best = end();
7629 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
7630 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007631 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007632 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007633 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007634 }
7635
7636 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007637 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007638 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
7639
7640 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
7641 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007642 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007643 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007644 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007645 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007646 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007647 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007648 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007649 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007650 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007651
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007652 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007653 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007654 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
7655 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007656 return OR_Deleted;
7657
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007658 return OR_Success;
7659}
7660
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007661namespace {
7662
7663enum OverloadCandidateKind {
7664 oc_function,
7665 oc_method,
7666 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007667 oc_function_template,
7668 oc_method_template,
7669 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007670 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
7671 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007672 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007673 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007674 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007675 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007676};
7677
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007678OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
7679 FunctionDecl *Fn,
7680 std::string &Description) {
7681 bool isTemplate = false;
7682
7683 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
7684 isTemplate = true;
7685 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7686 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
7687 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007688
7689 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007690 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007691 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007692
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007693 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
7694 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
7695
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007696 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
7697 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
7698
7699 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
7700 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
7701
7702 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
7703 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
7704 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007705 }
7706
7707 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7708 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
7709 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007710 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007711 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007712
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007713 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
7714 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
7715
Douglas Gregor12695102012-02-10 08:36:38 +00007716 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
7717 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
7718
7719 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
7720 return oc_method;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007721 }
7722
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007723 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007724}
7725
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007726void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
7727 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
7728 if (!Ctor) return;
7729
7730 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
7731 if (!Ctor) return;
7732
7733 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
7734}
7735
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007736} // end anonymous namespace
7737
7738// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007739void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007740 std::string FnDesc;
7741 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007742 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7743 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
7744 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
7745 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007746 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007747}
7748
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007749//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
7750// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007751void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007752 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7753
7754 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
7755 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
7756
7757 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7758 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7759 I != IEnd; ++I) {
7760 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
7761 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007762 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007763 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
7764 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007765 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007766 }
7767 }
7768}
7769
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007770/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
7771/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
7772/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007773void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
7774 Sema &S,
7775 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7776 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
7777 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
7778 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007779 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007780 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7781 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007782 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007783}
7784
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007785namespace {
7786
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007787void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
7788 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
7789 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007790 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
7791 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7792
7793 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
7794 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
7795 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007796 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007797 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007798 if (I == 0)
7799 isObjectArgument = true;
7800 else
7801 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007802 }
7803
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007804 std::string FnDesc;
7805 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
7806
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007807 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
7808 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
7809 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007810
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007811 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007812 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007813 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
7814 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
7815 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007816 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007817
7818 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
7819 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7820 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7821 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007822 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007823 return;
7824 }
7825
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007826 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
7827 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007828 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
7829 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
7830 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7831 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
7832 else {
7833 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
7834 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7835 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7836 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
7837 }
7838
7839 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
7840 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
7841 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
7842 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
7843 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
7844 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
7845 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
7846
7847 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7848 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7849
7850 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
7851 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
7852 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7853 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7854 << FromTy
7855 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
7856 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007857 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007858 return;
7859 }
7860
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007861 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscff00d92011-06-24 00:08:59 +00007862 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007863 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7864 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7865 << FromTy
7866 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
7867 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7868 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7869 return;
7870 }
7871
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00007872 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
7873 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
7874 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7875 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7876 << FromTy
7877 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
7878 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7879 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7880 return;
7881 }
7882
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007883 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
7884 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
7885
7886 if (isObjectArgument) {
7887 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
7888 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7889 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7890 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
7891 } else {
7892 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
7893 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7894 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7895 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
7896 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007897 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007898 return;
7899 }
7900
Sebastian Redla72462c2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00007901 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
7902 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
7903 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
7904 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
7905 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7906 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7907 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7908 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7909 return;
7910 }
7911
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007912 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
7913 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
7914 // the failure.
7915 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
7916 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7917 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7918 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
7919 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
7920 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7921 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7922 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007923 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007924 return;
7925 }
7926
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007927 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007928 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007929 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7930 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7931 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
7932 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
7933 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7934 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007935 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007936 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007937 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007938 }
7939 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
7940 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
7941 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
7942 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
7943 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
7944 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
7945 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
7946 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
7947 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007948 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
7949 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
7950 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
7951 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
7952 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7953 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
7954 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
7955 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007956
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007957 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007958 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007959 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007960 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7961 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007962 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007963 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007964 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007965 return;
7966 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007967
Fariborz Jahaniana644f9c2011-07-20 17:14:09 +00007968 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
7969 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
7970 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7971 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7972 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
7973 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
7974 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7975 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7976 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7977 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7978 return;
7979 }
7980 }
7981
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007982 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
7983 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
7984 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007985 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007986 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
7987 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
7988
7989 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer490afa62012-01-14 21:05:10 +00007990 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
7991 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007992 FDiag << *HI;
7993 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
7994
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007995 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007996}
7997
7998void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7999 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8000 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8001
8002 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8003 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8004
8005 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008006
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008007 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8008 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
8009 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8010 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8011 // Just don't report anything.
8012 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8013 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8014 return;
8015
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008016 // at least / at most / exactly
8017 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8018 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008019 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8020 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8021 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008022 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregor7825bf32011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008023 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008024 mode = 0; // "at least"
8025 else
8026 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8027 modeCount = MinParams;
8028 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008029 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8030 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8031 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008032 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8033 mode = 1; // "at most"
8034 else
8035 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8036 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8037 }
8038
8039 std::string Description;
8040 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8041
8042 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008043 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008044 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008045 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008046}
8047
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008048/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8049void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8050 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8051 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
8052
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008053 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008054 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8055 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8056 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8057 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008058 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
8059 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8060 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8061
8062 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008063 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8064 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8065 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008066 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008067 return;
8068 }
8069
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008070 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8071 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8072 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8073
8074 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8075
8076 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8077 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008078 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008079 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008080 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008081 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8082
8083 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8084 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8085 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8086 // done on dependent types).
8087 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8088
8089 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8090 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008091 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008092 return;
8093 }
8094
8095 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008096 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008097 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008098 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008099 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008100 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008101 which = 1;
8102 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008103 which = 2;
8104 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008105
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008106 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008107 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008108 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8109 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008110 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008111 return;
8112 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008113
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008114 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008115 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008116 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008117 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008118 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8119 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8120 else {
8121 int index = 0;
8122 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8123 index = TTP->getIndex();
8124 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8125 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8126 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8127 else
8128 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008129 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008130 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8131 << (index + 1);
8132 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008133 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008134 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008135
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008136 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8137 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8138 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
8139 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008140
8141 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8142 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008143 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008144 return;
8145
8146 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
8147 std::string ArgString;
8148 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
8149 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
8150 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8151 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
8152 *Args);
8153 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
8154 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008155 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008156 return;
8157 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008158
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008159 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8160 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008161 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008162 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8163 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008164 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008165 return;
8166 }
8167}
8168
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008169/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8170void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8171 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8172 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8173
8174 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8175 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8176
8177 std::string FnDesc;
8178 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8179
8180 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8181 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8182}
8183
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008184/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8185/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8186///
8187/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8188/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8189/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8190/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8191/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8192/// overload.
8193///
8194/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8195/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8196/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008197void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8198 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008199 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8200
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008201 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008202 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8203 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008204 std::string FnDesc;
8205 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008206
8207 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008208 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008209 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008210 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008211 }
8212
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008213 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8214 if (Cand->Viable) {
8215 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8216 return;
8217 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008218
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008219 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8220 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8221 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8222 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008223
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008224 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008225 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
8226
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008227 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8228 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008229 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008230 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008231
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008232 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8233 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008234 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008235 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8236 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008237
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008238 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8239 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8240 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8241 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008242 }
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008243
8244 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8245 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008246 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008247}
8248
8249void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8250 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8251 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8252 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8253 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8254 bool isLValueReference = false;
8255 bool isRValueReference = false;
8256 bool isPointer = false;
8257 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8258 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8259 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8260 isLValueReference = true;
8261 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8262 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8263 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8264 isRValueReference = true;
8265 }
8266 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8267 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8268 isPointer = true;
8269 }
8270 // Desugar down to a function type.
8271 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8272 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8273 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8274 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8275 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8276
8277 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8278 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008279 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008280}
8281
8282void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
8283 const char *Opc,
8284 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8285 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008286 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008287 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8288 TypeStr += Opc;
8289 TypeStr += "(";
8290 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008291 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008292 TypeStr += ")";
8293 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8294 } else {
8295 TypeStr += ", ";
8296 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8297 TypeStr += ")";
8298 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8299 }
8300}
8301
8302void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8303 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008304 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008305 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8306 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008307 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8308 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8309
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008310 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008311 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008312 }
8313}
8314
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008315SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8316 if (Cand->Function)
8317 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008318 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008319 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8320 return SourceLocation();
8321}
8322
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008323static unsigned
8324RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth73fddfe2011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008325 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008326 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008327 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008328
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008329 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8330 return 1;
8331
8332 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8333 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8334 return 2;
8335
8336 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8337 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
8338 return 3;
8339
8340 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8341 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8342 return 4;
8343
8344 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8345 return 5;
8346
8347 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8348 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8349 return 6;
8350 }
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008351 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008352}
8353
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008354struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8355 Sema &S;
8356 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008357
8358 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8359 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008360 // Fast-path this check.
8361 if (L == R) return false;
8362
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008363 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008364 if (L->Viable) {
8365 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8366
8367 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8368 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8369 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008370 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8371 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008372 } else if (R->Viable)
8373 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008374
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008375 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008376
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008377 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8378 if (!L->Viable) {
8379 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8380 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8381 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8382 return false;
8383 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8384 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8385 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008386
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008387 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8388 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8389 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8390 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8391 return true;
8392
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008393 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8394 // comes first.
8395 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8396 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8397 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8398 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008399 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008400 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8401 return true;
8402 else
8403 return false;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008404 }
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008405
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008406 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8407 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008408 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008409
8410 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008411 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008412 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008413 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8414 L->Conversions[I],
8415 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008416 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8417 leftBetter++;
8418 break;
8419
8420 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8421 leftBetter--;
8422 break;
8423
8424 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8425 break;
8426 }
8427 }
8428 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8429 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8430
8431 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8432 return false;
8433
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008434 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8435 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8436 return true;
8437
8438 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8439 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedman1e7a0c62011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008440 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedmane2c600c2011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008441 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8442 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008443
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008444 // TODO: others?
8445 }
8446
8447 // Sort everything else by location.
8448 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8449 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8450
8451 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8452 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8453 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8454
8455 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008456 }
8457};
8458
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008459/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008460/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008461void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8462 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8463 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8464
8465 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8466 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8467
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008468 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8469 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008470 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8471 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008472
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008473 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008474 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008475 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008476 while (true) {
8477 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8478 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008479 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008480 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008481 break;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008482 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008483 }
8484
8485 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8486 return;
8487
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008488 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8489 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8490
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008491 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008492 // operation somehow.
8493 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008494
8495 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
8496 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
8497
8498 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
8499 QualType ConvType
8500 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8501 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8502 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
8503 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8504 ArgIdx--;
8505 } else if (Cand->Function) {
8506 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8507 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
8508 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
8509 ArgIdx--;
8510 } else {
8511 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
8512 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
8513 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
8514 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008515 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
8516 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008517 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008518 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
8519 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
8520 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008521 return;
8522 }
8523
8524 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
8525 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8526 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008527 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008528 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008529 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008530 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008531 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
8532 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
8533 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008534 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
8535 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008536 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008537 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008538 else
8539 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
8540 }
8541}
8542
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008543} // end anonymous namespace
8544
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008545/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
8546/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008547/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008548void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
8549 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
8550 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8551 const char *Opc,
8552 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008553 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
8554 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008555 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008556 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
8557 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008558 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008559 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008560 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008561 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008562 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
8563 Cands.push_back(Cand);
8564 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
8565 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008566 }
8567 }
8568
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008569 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008570 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008571
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008572 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008573
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008574 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00008575 const DiagnosticsEngine::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads =
8576 S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008577 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008578 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8579 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00008580
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008581 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
8582 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
8583 // candidate list.
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00008584 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == DiagnosticsEngine::Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008585 break;
8586 }
8587 ++CandsShown;
8588
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008589 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008590 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008591 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008592 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008593 else {
8594 assert(Cand->Viable &&
8595 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008596 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
8597 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
8598 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
8599 //
8600 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
8601 // different ambiguities, though.
8602 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008603 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008604 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
8605 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008606
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008607 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008608 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008609 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008610 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008611
8612 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008613 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008614}
8615
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008616// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
8617// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
8618// R (A) --> R(A)
8619// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
8620// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
8621// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
8622QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
8623 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
8624 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
8625 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
8626 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8627 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
8628 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8629 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008630 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008631 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8632 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8633 Ret =
8634 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
8635 return Ret;
8636}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008637
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008638// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
8639// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
8640class AddressOfFunctionResolver
8641{
8642 Sema& S;
8643 Expr* SourceExpr;
8644 const QualType& TargetType;
8645 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
8646
8647 bool Complain;
8648 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
8649 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008650
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008651 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
8652 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008653
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008654 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
8655 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
8656 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008657 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008658
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008659public:
8660 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
8661 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
8662 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
8663 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
8664 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
8665 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
8666 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
8667 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
8668 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
8669 {
8670 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
8671
8672 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
8673 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8674 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008675 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008676 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00008677
8678 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8679 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
8680 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
8681 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
8682 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
8683 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
8684
8685 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
8686 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
8687 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
8688 return;
8689 }
8690 }
8691
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008692 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
8693 }
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00008694 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008695 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00008696 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008697
8698 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
8699 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008700
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008701 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
8702 // C++ [over.over]p4:
8703 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
8704 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
8705 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
8706 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
8707 else
8708 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
8709 }
8710 }
8711 }
8712
8713private:
8714 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
8715 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
8716 }
8717
8718 // [ToType] [Return]
8719
8720 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
8721 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
8722 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
8723 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
8724 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
8725 }
8726
8727 // return true if any matching specializations were found
8728 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
8729 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
8730 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
8731 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
8732 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
8733 // static when converting to member pointer.
8734 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8735 return false;
8736 }
8737 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8738 return false;
8739
8740 // C++ [over.over]p2:
8741 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
8742 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
8743 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
8744 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
8745 // overloaded functions considered.
8746 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
8747 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
8748 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
8749 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
8750 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
8751 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
8752 Info)) {
8753 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
8754 (void)Result;
8755 return false;
8756 }
8757
8758 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
8759 // This function template specicalization works.
8760 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
8761 assert(TargetFunctionType
8762 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
8763 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
8764 return true;
8765 }
8766
8767 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
8768 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00008769 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008770 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
8771 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008772 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8773 return false;
8774 }
8775 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8776 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008777
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00008778 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008779 if (S.getLangOptions().CUDA)
8780 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
8781 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
8782 return false;
8783
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00008784 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008785 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
8786 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00008787 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
8788 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008789 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
8790 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00008791 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008792 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00008793 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008794 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008795
8796 return false;
8797 }
8798
8799 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
8800 bool Ret = false;
8801
8802 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
8803 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
8804 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
8805 return false;
8806
8807 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8808 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8809 I != E; ++I) {
8810 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
8811 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
8812
8813 // C++ [over.over]p3:
8814 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
8815 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
8816 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
8817 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
8818 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
8819 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
8820 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
8821 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
8822 Ret = true;
8823 }
8824 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
8825 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
8826 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
8827 Ret = true;
8828 }
8829 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
8830 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008831 }
8832
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008833 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008834 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
8835 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
8836 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
8837 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
8838 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
8839
8840 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
8841 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
8842 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
8843 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008844
8845 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
8846 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
8847 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008848
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008849 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008850 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
8851 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
8852 S.PDiag(),
8853 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8854 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
8855 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8856 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008857 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008858
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008859 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
8860 // Make it the first and only element
8861 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
8862 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
8863 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008864 }
8865 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008866
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008867 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
8868 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
8869 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
8870 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
8871 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
8872 ++I;
8873 else {
8874 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
8875 Matches.set_size(N);
8876 }
8877 }
8878 }
8879
8880public:
8881 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
8882 assert(Matches.empty());
8883 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
8884 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
8885 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008886 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008887 }
8888
8889 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
8890 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
8891 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
8892 }
8893
8894 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
8895 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
8896 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
8897 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
8898 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
8899 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
8900 }
8901
8902 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
8903 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
8904 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
8905 }
8906
8907 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
8908 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
8909 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8910 << OvlExpr->getName()
8911 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008912 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008913 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008914
8915 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
8916
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008917 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
8918
8919 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
8920 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
8921 return Matches[0].second;
8922 }
8923
8924 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
8925 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
8926 return &Matches[0].first;
8927 }
8928};
8929
8930/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
8931/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
8932/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
8933/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
8934///
8935/// @code
8936/// int f(double);
8937/// int f(int);
8938///
8939/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
8940/// @endcode
8941///
8942/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
8943/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
8944/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
8945FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008946Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
8947 QualType TargetType,
8948 bool Complain,
8949 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
8950 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008951 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008952
8953 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
8954 Complain);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008955 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
8956 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008957 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008958 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
8959 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
8960 else
8961 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
8962 }
8963 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
8964 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
8965 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
8966 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
8967 assert(Fn);
8968 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00008969 MarkFunctionReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00008970 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008971 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00008972 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008973
8974 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
8975 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008976 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008977}
8978
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008979/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008980/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
8981///
8982/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
8983/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008984/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008985/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008986FunctionDecl *
8987Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
8988 bool Complain,
8989 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008990 // C++ [over.over]p1:
8991 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
8992 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008993 // C++ [over.over]p1:
8994 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
8995 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008996
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008997 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008998 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008999 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009000
9001 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009002 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009003
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009004 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9005 // whose type matches exactly.
9006 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009007 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9008 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009009 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9010 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009011 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9012 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9013 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009014 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009015 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9016 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009017
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009018 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9019 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9020 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9021 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9022 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9023 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009024 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009025 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009026 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9027 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9028 Specialization, Info)) {
9029 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9030 (void)Result;
9031 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009032 }
9033
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009034 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9035
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009036 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009037 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009038 if (Complain) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009039 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9040 << ovl->getName();
9041 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009042 }
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009043 return 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009044 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009045
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009046 Matched = Specialization;
9047 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009048 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009049
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009050 return Matched;
9051}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009052
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009053
9054
9055
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009056// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9057// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9058//
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009059// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009060//
9061// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9062// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9063// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9064bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9065 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9066 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009067 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009068 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009069 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009070
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009071 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009072
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009073 DeclAccessPair found;
9074 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9075 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9076 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009077 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin())) {
9078 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9079 return true;
9080 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009081
9082 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9083 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9084 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9085 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9086 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9087 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9088 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009089 if (!complain) return false;
9090
9091 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9092 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9093 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9094
9095 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9096 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9097 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9098 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9099 // the static candidates were rejected.
9100 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9101 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009102 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009103
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009104 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'.
9105 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009106 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009107
9108 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009109 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009110 SingleFunctionExpression =
9111 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009112 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9113 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9114 return true;
9115 }
9116 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009117 }
9118
9119 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9120 if (complain) {
9121 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9122 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9123 << DestTypeForComplaining
9124 << OpRangeForComplaining
9125 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009126 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9127
9128 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9129 return true;
9130 }
9131
9132 return false;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009133 }
9134
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009135 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9136 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009137}
9138
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009139/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9140static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009141 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009142 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009143 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9144 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009145 bool PartialOverloading,
9146 bool KnownValid) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009147 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009148 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9149 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9150
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009151 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009152 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9153 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9154 return;
9155 }
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009156 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00009157 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009158 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009159 }
9160
9161 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9162 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009163 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
9164 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009165 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009166 return;
9167 }
9168
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009169 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009170}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009171
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009172/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9173/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009174void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009175 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9176 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9177 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009178
9179#ifndef NDEBUG
9180 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9181 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009182 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009183 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9184 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9185 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9186 //
9187 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9188 //
9189 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009190 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009191 //
9192 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9193 // template
9194 //
9195 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009196
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009197 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9198 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9199 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9200 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9201 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9202 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9203 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009204 }
9205 }
9206#endif
9207
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009208 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9209 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009210 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009211 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9212 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9213 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9214 }
9215
9216 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9217 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009218 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009219 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009220 PartialOverloading, /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009221
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009222 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009223 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithe06a2c12012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009224 ULE->getExprLoc(),
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009225 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009226 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009227 CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00009228 PartialOverloading,
9229 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace());
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009230}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009231
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009232/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9233/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9234/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9235/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9236///
9237/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9238static bool
9239DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9240 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9241 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9242 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
9243 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9244 return false;
9245
9246 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
9247 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9248
9249 if (!R.empty()) {
9250 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9251
9252 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9253 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9254 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9255 R.clear();
9256 return false;
9257 }
9258
9259 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9260 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9261 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
9262 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009263 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009264
9265 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009266 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009267 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9268 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009269 R.clear();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009270 return false;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009271 }
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009272
9273 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9274 // declaring the function there instead.
9275 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9276 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
9277 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(Args, NumArgs,
9278 AssociatedNamespaces,
9279 AssociatedClasses);
9280 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009281 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009282 if (DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009283 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9284 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009285 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
9286 if (!Std->Encloses(*it))
9287 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
9288 }
Chandler Carruthd54186a2011-06-08 10:13:17 +00009289 } else {
9290 // Lacking the 'std::' namespace, use all of the associated namespaces.
9291 SuggestedNamespaces = AssociatedNamespaces;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009292 }
9293
9294 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9295 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009296 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009297 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9298 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9299 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009300 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009301 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9302 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009303 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009304 } else {
9305 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9306 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9307 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9308 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9309 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9310 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9311 }
9312
9313 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9314 return true;
9315 }
9316
9317 R.clear();
9318 }
9319
9320 return false;
9321}
9322
9323/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9324/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9325/// was defined.
9326///
9327/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9328static bool
9329DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9330 SourceLocation OpLoc,
9331 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
9332 DeclarationName OpName =
9333 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9334 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9335 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
9336 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args, NumArgs);
9337}
9338
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009339namespace {
9340// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9341// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9342// that accept the given number of arguments.
9343class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9344 public:
9345 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9346 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9347 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus;
9348 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9349 }
9350
9351 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9352 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9353 return candidate.isKeyword();
9354
9355 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9356 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9357 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9358 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9359 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9360 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9361 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9362 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9363 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9364 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9365 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9366 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9367 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9368 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9369 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9370 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9371 return true;
9372 }
9373 }
9374 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9375 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9376 return true;
9377 }
9378 return false;
9379 }
9380
9381 private:
9382 unsigned NumArgs;
9383 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9384};
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009385
9386// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9387class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9388 public:
9389 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9390 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9391 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9392 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9393 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9394 }
9395
9396 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9397 return false;
9398 }
9399};
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009400}
9401
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009402/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9403///
9404/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009405static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009406BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009407 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9408 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9409 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009410 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009411 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009412
9413 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009414 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009415 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009416
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009417 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009418 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009419 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9420 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9421 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9422 }
9423
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009424 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9425 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009426 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, NumArgs, ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009427 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9428 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9429 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9430 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009431 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
9432 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs) &&
9433 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009434 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Kaelyn Uhrain42830922011-08-05 00:09:52 +00009435 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs)))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009436 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009437
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009438 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
9439
9440 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
9441 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009442 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009443 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009444 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
9445 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara65f7c3d2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009446 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009447 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara65f7c3d2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009448 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009449 else
9450 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
9451
9452 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009453 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009454
9455 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009456 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009457 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009458 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00009459 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009460}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00009461
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009462/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00009463/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
9464/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
9465/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
9466/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00009467/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009468/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009469ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009470Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009471 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9472 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00009473 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009474 Expr *ExecConfig,
9475 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009476#ifndef NDEBUG
9477 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9478 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
9479 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
9480
9481 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
9482 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
9483 FunctionDecl *F;
9484 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
9485 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
9486 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009487 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009488
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009489 // We don't perform ADL in C.
9490 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00009491 } else
9492 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() &&
9493 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL");
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009494#endif
9495
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009496 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
9497 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
9498 return ExprError();
9499
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009500 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00009501
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009502 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
9503 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
9504 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009505
9506 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009507 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
9508 // out if it fails.
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009509 if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009510 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
9511 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009512 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009513 // classes.
Francois Pichetf707ae62011-11-11 00:12:11 +00009514 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetde232cb2011-11-25 01:10:54 +00009515 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009516 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
9517 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
9518 RParenLoc);
9519 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
9520 return Owned(CE);
9521 }
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009522 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009523 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
9524 AllowTypoCorrection);
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009525 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009526
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009527 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
9528
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009529 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009530 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009531 case OR_Success: {
9532 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00009533 MarkFunctionReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009534 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009535 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009536 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00009537 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
9538 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009539 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009540
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009541 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9542 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
9543 // have meant to call.
9544 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
9545 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009546 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
9547 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009548 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
9549 return Recovery;
9550
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00009551 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009552 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009553 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009554 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009555 break;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009556 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009557
9558 case OR_Ambiguous:
9559 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009560 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009561 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009562 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009563
9564 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00009565 {
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009566 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
9567 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9568 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009569 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009570 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00009571 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3eaa22a2011-11-04 15:58:13 +00009572
9573 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
9574 // the call in the AST.
9575 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
9576 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9577 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9578 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00009579 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009580 }
9581
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009582 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009583 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009584}
9585
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009586static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00009587 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
9588 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
9589}
9590
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009591/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
9592/// operator.
9593///
9594/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
9595///
9596/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
9597/// operator.
9598///
9599/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
9600/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
9601/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
9602/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
9603/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
9604/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
9605///
9606/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009607ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009608Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
9609 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009610 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009611 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009612
9613 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
9614 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
9615 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009616 // TODO: provide better source location info.
9617 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009618
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009619 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
9620 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009621
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009622 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
9623 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009624
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009625 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
9626 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
9627 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009628 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009629 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00009630 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
9631 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009632 NumArgs = 2;
9633 }
9634
9635 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009636 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009637 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009638 Opc,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009639 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009640 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009641 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009642
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009643 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009644 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00009645 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009646 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00009647 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
9648 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009649 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009650 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009651 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009652 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009653 OpLoc));
9654 }
9655
9656 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009657 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009658
9659 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009660 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009661
9662 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9663 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
9664
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009665 // Add candidates from ADL.
9666 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Richard Smithe06a2c12012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009667 OpLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009668 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
9669 CandidateSet);
9670
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009671 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00009672 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009673
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009674 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9675
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009676 // Perform overload resolution.
9677 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009678 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009679 case OR_Success: {
9680 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9681 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009682
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009683 if (FnDecl) {
9684 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9685 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009686
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00009687 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009688
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009689 // Convert the arguments.
9690 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009691 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009692
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009693 ExprResult InputRes =
9694 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
9695 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9696 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009697 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009698 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009699 } else {
9700 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009701 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00009702 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009703 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00009704 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009705 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009706 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00009707 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009708 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009709 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009710 }
9711
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009712 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
9713
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009714 // Determine the result type.
9715 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9716 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9717 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009718
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009719 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009720 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +00009721 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009722 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9723 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009724
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00009725 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009726 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009727 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009728 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009729
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009730 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00009731 FnDecl))
9732 return ExprError();
9733
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009734 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009735 } else {
9736 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9737 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9738 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009739 ExprResult InputRes =
9740 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9741 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9742 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
9743 return ExprError();
9744 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009745 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009746 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009747 }
9748
9749 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009750 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
9751 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
9752 // defined too late to be candidates.
9753 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, NumArgs))
9754 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
9755 return ExprError();
9756
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009757 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
9758 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
9759 break;
9760
9761 case OR_Ambiguous:
9762 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
9763 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9764 << Input->getType()
9765 << Input->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00009766 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009767 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
9768 return ExprError();
9769
9770 case OR_Deleted:
9771 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9772 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9773 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9774 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
9775 << Input->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00009776 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
9777 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009778 return ExprError();
9779 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009780
9781 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
9782 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
9783 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009784 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009785}
9786
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009787/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
9788/// operator.
9789///
9790/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
9791///
9792/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
9793/// operator.
9794///
9795/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
9796/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
9797/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
9798/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
9799/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
9800/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
9801///
9802/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
9803/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009804ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009805Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009806 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009807 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009808 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009809 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009810 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009811
9812 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
9813 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
9814 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9815
9816 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
9817 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009818 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009819 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009820 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009821 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009822 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009823 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009824 Context.DependentTy,
9825 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9826 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009827
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009828 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
9829 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009830 VK_LValue,
9831 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009832 Context.DependentTy,
9833 Context.DependentTy,
9834 OpLoc));
9835 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009836
9837 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009838 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009839 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
9840 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009841 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009842 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
9843 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
9844 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00009845 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009846 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009847 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009848 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009849 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009850 OpLoc));
9851 }
9852
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009853 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
9854 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
9855 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009856
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00009857 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
9858 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
9859 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009860 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
9861 return ExprError();
9862
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00009863 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
9864 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
9865 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
9866 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
9867 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
9868 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009869 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009870 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009871
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009872 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
9873 // create a built-in binary operator.
9874 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
9875 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
9876
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009877 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009878 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009879
9880 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009881 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009882
9883 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9884 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9885
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009886 // Add candidates from ADL.
9887 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Richard Smithe06a2c12012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009888 OpLoc, Args, 2,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009889 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
9890 CandidateSet);
9891
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009892 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00009893 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009894
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009895 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9896
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009897 // Perform overload resolution.
9898 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009899 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00009900 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009901 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9902 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
9903
9904 if (FnDecl) {
9905 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9906 // operator.
9907
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +00009908 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009909
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009910 // Convert the arguments.
9911 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009912 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009913 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009914
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009915 ExprResult Arg1 =
9916 PerformCopyInitialization(
9917 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9918 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9919 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009920 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009921 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009922
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009923 ExprResult Arg0 =
9924 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
9925 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9926 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009927 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009928 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009929 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009930 } else {
9931 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009932 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
9933 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9934 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9935 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009936 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009937 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009938
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009939 ExprResult Arg1 =
9940 PerformCopyInitialization(
9941 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9942 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
9943 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009944 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
9945 return ExprError();
9946 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
9947 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009948 }
9949
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009950 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
9951
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009952 // Determine the result type.
9953 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9954 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9955 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009956
9957 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009958 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
9959 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009960 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9961 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009962
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009963 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009964 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009965 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009966
9967 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009968 FnDecl))
9969 return ExprError();
9970
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009971 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009972 } else {
9973 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9974 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9975 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009976 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
9977 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9978 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9979 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009980 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009981 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009982
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009983 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
9984 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
9985 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
9986 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
9987 return ExprError();
9988 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009989 break;
9990 }
9991 }
9992
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009993 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9994 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
9995 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
9996 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
9997 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009998 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009999 break;
10000
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010001 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10002 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10003 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010004 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010005 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010006 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10008 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010009 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010010 } else {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010011 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10012 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10013 // defined too late to be candidates.
10014 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, 2))
10015 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10016 return ExprError();
10017
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010018 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10019 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10020 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010021 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010022 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010023 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10024 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010025 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
10026 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010027 return move(Result);
10028 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010029
10030 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010031 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010032 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010033 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010034 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010035 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
10036 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010037 return ExprError();
10038
10039 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregor74f7d502012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010040 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10041 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10042 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
10043 << getSpecialMember(Method)
10044 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10045 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function);
10046
10047 if (Method->getParent()->isLambda()) {
10048 Diag(Method->getParent()->getLocation(), diag::note_lambda_decl);
10049 return ExprError();
10050 }
10051 } else {
10052 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10053 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10054 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10055 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10056 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10057 }
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010058 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
10059 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010060 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010061 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010062
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010063 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010064 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010065}
10066
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010067ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010068Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10069 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010070 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10071 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010072 DeclarationName OpName =
10073 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10074
10075 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10076 // expression.
10077 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10078
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010079 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010080 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10081 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10082 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010083 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010084 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010085 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010086 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10087 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10088 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010089 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010090
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010091 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
10092 Args, 2,
10093 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010094 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010095 RLoc));
10096 }
10097
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010098 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10099 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10100 return ExprError();
10101 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10102 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010103
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010104 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010105 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010106
10107 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10108
10109 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10110 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10111
10112 // Add builtin operator candidates.
10113 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10114
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010115 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10116
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010117 // Perform overload resolution.
10118 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010119 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010120 case OR_Success: {
10121 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10122 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10123
10124 if (FnDecl) {
10125 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10126 // operator.
10127
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010128 MarkFunctionReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +000010129
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010130 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010131 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010132
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010133 // Convert the arguments.
10134 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010135 ExprResult Arg0 =
10136 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10137 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10138 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010139 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010140 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010141
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010142 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010143 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010144 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010145 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010146 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010147 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010148 Owned(Args[1]));
10149 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10150 return ExprError();
10151
10152 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10153
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010154 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010155 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10156 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10157 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010158
10159 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010160 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10161 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010162 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
10163 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010164 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10165 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010166 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10167 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010168
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010169 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10170 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010171 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010172 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010173
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010174 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010175 FnDecl))
10176 return ExprError();
10177
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010178 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010179 } else {
10180 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10181 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10182 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010183 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10184 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10185 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10186 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010187 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010188 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10189
10190 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10191 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10192 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10193 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10194 return ExprError();
10195 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010196
10197 break;
10198 }
10199 }
10200
10201 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010202 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10203 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10204 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10205 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10206 else
10207 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10208 << Args[0]->getType()
10209 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010210 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
10211 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010212 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010213 }
10214
10215 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010216 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010217 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010218 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10219 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010220 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
10221 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010222 return ExprError();
10223
10224 case OR_Deleted:
10225 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10226 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010227 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010228 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010229 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
10230 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010231 return ExprError();
10232 }
10233
10234 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010235 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010236}
10237
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010238/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10239/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10240/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10241/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10242/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010243/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10244/// member function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010245ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010246Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
10247 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010248 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010249 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10250 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10251
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010252 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10253 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010254 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010255
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010256 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10257 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10258 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10259 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10260
10261 QualType fnType =
10262 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10263
10264 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10265 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10266 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10267
10268 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10269 // member function we're calling.
10270 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10271
10272 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10273 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10274 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10275 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10276
10277 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10278 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10279 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10280 if (difference) {
10281 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10282 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10283 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10284 << qualsString
10285 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10286 }
10287
10288 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
10289 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
10290 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10291
10292 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
10293 op->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
10294 call, 0))
10295 return ExprError();
10296
10297 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
10298 return ExprError();
10299
10300 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10301 }
10302
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010303 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10304 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10305 return ExprError();
10306
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010307 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010308 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010309 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010310 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010311 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10312 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010313 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010314 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010315 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010316 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010317 } else {
10318 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010319 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010320
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010321 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010322 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10323 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10324 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010325
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010326 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010327 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010328
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010329 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10330 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10331 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10332 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10333 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10334 }
10335
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010336 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10337 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10338
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010339 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10340 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10341 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10342 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10343
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010344
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010345 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +000010346 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010347 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
10348 CandidateSet);
10349 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010350 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10351 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010352 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010353 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010354
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010355 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010356 ObjectClassification,
10357 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010358 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010359 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010360 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010361 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010362 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010363 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010364 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010365 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010366 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010367
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010368 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10369
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010370 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10371
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010372 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010373 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010374 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010375 case OR_Success:
10376 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010377 MarkFunctionReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010378 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010379 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010380 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010381 break;
10382
10383 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010384 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010385 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010386 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010387 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010388 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010389 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010390
10391 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010392 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010393 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010394 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010395 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010396 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010397
10398 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010399 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010400 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010401 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010402 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010403 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010404 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010405 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010406 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010407 }
10408
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010409 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010410
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010411 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
10412 // non-member call based on that function.
10413 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10414 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
10415 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
10416 }
10417
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010418 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010419 }
10420
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010421 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
10422 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
10423 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10424
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010425 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010426 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010427 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010428 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010429
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +000010430 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010431 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010432 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010433 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010434
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010435 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010436 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
10437 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010438 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10439 ExprResult ObjectArg =
10440 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
10441 FoundDecl, Method);
10442 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
10443 return ExprError();
10444 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
10445 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010446
10447 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010448 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10449 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010450 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010451 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010452 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010453
Eli Friedmanff4b4072012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010454 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10455
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010456 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010457 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +000010458
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010459 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
10460 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
10461 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
10462 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
10463
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010464 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010465 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
10466 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
10467 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
10468 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
10469
10470 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010471 }
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010472 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010473 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010474}
10475
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010476/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10477/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10478/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10479/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010480ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010481Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +000010482 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010483 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010484 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010485 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
10486 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010487 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010488
10489 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10490 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10491 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010492
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010493 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
10494 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010495
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010496 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
10497 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +000010498 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010499 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
10500 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
10501 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
10502 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010503 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000010504 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010505
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010506 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +000010507 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010508 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010509 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010510
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010511 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10512 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
10513 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10514
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010515 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010516 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010517 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
10518 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +000010519 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010520 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010521
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010522 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010523 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
10524 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010525 //
10526 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
10527 //
10528 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
10529 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +000010530 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
10531 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
10532 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
10533 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010534 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
10535 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
10536 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
10537 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
10538 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +000010539 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +000010540 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +000010541 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010542 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010543 NamedDecl *D = *I;
10544 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
10545 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
10546 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010547
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010548 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
10549 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010550 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010551 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +000010552
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010553 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010554 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
10555 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
10556 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
10557 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
10558 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
10559 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010560
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010561 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10562 {
10563 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
10564 Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
10565 }
10566 }
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010567 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010568
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010569 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10570
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010571 // Perform overload resolution.
10572 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010573 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010574 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010575 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010576 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
10577 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010578 break;
10579
10580 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010581 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010582 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10583 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
10584 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010585 else
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010586 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010587 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010588 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010589 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010590 break;
10591
10592 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010593 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010594 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010595 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010596 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010597 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010598
10599 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010600 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010601 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
10602 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010603 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010604 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010605 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010606 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010607 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010608 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010609
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010610 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010611 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010612
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010613 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10614
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010615 if (Best->Function == 0) {
10616 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
10617 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010618 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010619 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
10620 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
10621
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010622 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010623 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +000010624
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010625 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
10626 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
10627 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010628
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +000010629 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +000010630 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010631 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
10632 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +000010633 if (Call.isInvalid())
10634 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +000010635 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
10636 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
10637 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
10638 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010639
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +000010640 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010641 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010642 }
10643
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010644 MarkFunctionReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010645 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010646 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +000010647
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010648 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
10649 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
10650 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
10651 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010652 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10653 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010654
10655 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
10656 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
10657
10658 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
10659 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
10660 // list).
10661 Expr **MethodArgs;
10662 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
10663 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
10664 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
10665 } else {
10666 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
10667 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010668 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010669 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
10670 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010671
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010672 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
10673 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
10674 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010675 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010676 HadMultipleCandidates,
10677 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10678 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010679 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
10680 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010681
10682 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
10683 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010684 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
10685 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10686 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10687
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010688 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010689 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010690 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010691 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010692 delete [] MethodArgs;
10693
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010694 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +000010695 Method))
10696 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010697
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010698 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
10699 // slots in the call for them.
10700 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +000010701 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010702 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
10703 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
10704
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010705 bool IsError = false;
10706
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010707 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010708 ExprResult ObjRes =
10709 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
10710 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10711 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
10712 IsError = true;
10713 else
10714 Object = move(ObjRes);
10715 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010716
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010717 // Check the argument types.
10718 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010719 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010720 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010721 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010722
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010723 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010724
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010725 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010726 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010727 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010728 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010729 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010730
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010731 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
10732 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010733 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010734 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000010735 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
10736 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
10737 IsError = true;
10738 break;
10739 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010740
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000010741 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010742 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010743
10744 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
10745 }
10746
10747 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
10748 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
10749 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
10750 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010751 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
10752 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
10753 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010754 }
10755 }
10756
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010757 if (IsError) return true;
10758
Eli Friedmanff4b4072012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010759 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10760
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010761 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +000010762 return true;
10763
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +000010764 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010765}
10766
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010767/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010768/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010769/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010770ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010771Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010772 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
10773 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010774
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010775 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
10776 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010777
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010778 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
10779
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010780 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
10781 //
10782 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
10783 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
10784 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
10785 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010786 DeclarationName OpName =
10787 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010788 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +000010789 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010790
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010791 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +000010792 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
10793 << Base->getSourceRange()))
10794 return ExprError();
10795
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010796 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10797 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
10798 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +000010799
10800 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010801 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010802 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
10803 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010804 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010805
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010806 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10807
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010808 // Perform overload resolution.
10809 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010810 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010811 case OR_Success:
10812 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
10813 break;
10814
10815 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
10816 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10817 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010818 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010819 else
10820 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010821 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010822 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010823 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010824
10825 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010826 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10827 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010828 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010829 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010830
10831 case OR_Deleted:
10832 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10833 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010834 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010835 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010836 << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010837 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010838 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010839 }
10840
Eli Friedmanfa0df832012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010841 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010842 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010843 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010844
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010845 // Convert the object parameter.
10846 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010847 ExprResult BaseResult =
10848 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10849 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10850 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010851 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010852 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +000010853
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010854 // Build the operator call.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010855 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa2a299e2012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010856 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010857 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10858 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010859
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010860 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
10861 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10862 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010863 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010864 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010865 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010866
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010867 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010868 Method))
10869 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +000010870
10871 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010872}
10873
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010874/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
10875/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
10876/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
10877/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +000010878/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +000010879Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010880 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010881 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010882 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
10883 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010884 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010885 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010886
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010887 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010888 }
10889
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010890 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010891 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
10892 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010893 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010894 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +000010895 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000010896 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010897 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010898 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010899
10900 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000010901 ICE->getCastKind(),
10902 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000010903 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010904 }
10905
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010906 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010907 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010908 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000010909 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10910 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10911 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
10912 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010913 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010914 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
10915 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
10916 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010917 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
10918 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010919 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010920 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010921
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010922 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
10923 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
10924 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
10925 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
10926
10927 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
10928 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
10929 // appropriate pointer to member type.
10930 QualType ClassType
10931 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
10932 QualType MemPtrType
10933 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
10934
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010935 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
10936 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
10937 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000010938 }
10939 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010940 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
10941 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010942 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010943 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010944
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010945 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010946 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010947 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010948 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010949 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010950
10951 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010952 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10953 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010954 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010955 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10956 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010957 }
10958
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010959 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
10960 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010961 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010962 Fn,
10963 ULE->getNameLoc(),
10964 Fn->getType(),
10965 VK_LValue,
10966 Found.getDecl(),
10967 TemplateArgs);
10968 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
10969 return DRE;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010970 }
10971
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010972 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010973 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010974 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10975 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10976 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10977 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10978 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010979
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010980 Expr *Base;
10981
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010982 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
10983 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010984 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
10985 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010986 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
10987 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010988 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010989 Fn,
10990 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
10991 Fn->getType(),
10992 VK_LValue,
10993 Found.getDecl(),
10994 TemplateArgs);
10995 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
10996 return DRE;
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000010997 } else {
10998 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
10999 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011000 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman73a04092012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011001 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011002 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11003 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11004 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11005 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011006 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011007 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011008
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011009 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11010 QualType type;
11011 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11012 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11013 type = Fn->getType();
11014 } else {
11015 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11016 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11017 }
11018
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011019 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11020 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11021 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011022 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011023 Fn,
11024 Found,
11025 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
11026 TemplateArgs,
11027 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
11028 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
11029 return ME;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011030 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011031
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011032 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011033}
11034
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011035ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011036 DeclAccessPair Found,
11037 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011038 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +000011039}
11040
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000011041} // end namespace clang